* config/i386/i386.md (mmx_pinsrw): Output operands in correct
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / reload1.c
blob151529ada8e0ee4e2fb2391cd837baae056266fb
1 /* Reload pseudo regs into hard regs for insns that require hard regs.
2 Copyright (C) 1987, 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998,
3 1999, 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU CC.
7 GNU CC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
12 GNU CC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU CC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
22 #include "config.h"
23 #include "system.h"
25 #include "machmode.h"
26 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
27 #include "rtl.h"
28 #include "tm_p.h"
29 #include "obstack.h"
30 #include "insn-config.h"
31 #include "insn-flags.h"
32 #include "insn-codes.h"
33 #include "flags.h"
34 #include "function.h"
35 #include "expr.h"
36 #include "regs.h"
37 #include "basic-block.h"
38 #include "reload.h"
39 #include "recog.h"
40 #include "output.h"
41 #include "cselib.h"
42 #include "real.h"
43 #include "toplev.h"
45 #if !defined PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY && defined STACK_BOUNDARY
46 #define PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY STACK_BOUNDARY
47 #endif
49 /* This file contains the reload pass of the compiler, which is
50 run after register allocation has been done. It checks that
51 each insn is valid (operands required to be in registers really
52 are in registers of the proper class) and fixes up invalid ones
53 by copying values temporarily into registers for the insns
54 that need them.
56 The results of register allocation are described by the vector
57 reg_renumber; the insns still contain pseudo regs, but reg_renumber
58 can be used to find which hard reg, if any, a pseudo reg is in.
60 The technique we always use is to free up a few hard regs that are
61 called ``reload regs'', and for each place where a pseudo reg
62 must be in a hard reg, copy it temporarily into one of the reload regs.
64 Reload regs are allocated locally for every instruction that needs
65 reloads. When there are pseudos which are allocated to a register that
66 has been chosen as a reload reg, such pseudos must be ``spilled''.
67 This means that they go to other hard regs, or to stack slots if no other
68 available hard regs can be found. Spilling can invalidate more
69 insns, requiring additional need for reloads, so we must keep checking
70 until the process stabilizes.
72 For machines with different classes of registers, we must keep track
73 of the register class needed for each reload, and make sure that
74 we allocate enough reload registers of each class.
76 The file reload.c contains the code that checks one insn for
77 validity and reports the reloads that it needs. This file
78 is in charge of scanning the entire rtl code, accumulating the
79 reload needs, spilling, assigning reload registers to use for
80 fixing up each insn, and generating the new insns to copy values
81 into the reload registers. */
83 #ifndef REGISTER_MOVE_COST
84 #define REGISTER_MOVE_COST(x, y) 2
85 #endif
87 #ifndef LOCAL_REGNO
88 #define LOCAL_REGNO(REGNO) 0
89 #endif
91 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains a REG rtx for the hard reg
92 into which reg N has been reloaded (perhaps for a previous insn). */
93 static rtx *reg_last_reload_reg;
95 /* Elt N nonzero if reg_last_reload_reg[N] has been set in this insn
96 for an output reload that stores into reg N. */
97 static char *reg_has_output_reload;
99 /* Indicates which hard regs are reload-registers for an output reload
100 in the current insn. */
101 static HARD_REG_SET reg_is_output_reload;
103 /* Element N is the constant value to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
104 or zero if pseudo reg N is not equivalent to a constant.
105 find_reloads looks at this in order to replace pseudo reg N
106 with the constant it stands for. */
107 rtx *reg_equiv_constant;
109 /* Element N is a memory location to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
110 prior to any register elimination (such as frame pointer to stack
111 pointer). Depending on whether or not it is a valid address, this value
112 is transferred to either reg_equiv_address or reg_equiv_mem. */
113 rtx *reg_equiv_memory_loc;
115 /* Element N is the address of stack slot to which pseudo reg N is equivalent.
116 This is used when the address is not valid as a memory address
117 (because its displacement is too big for the machine.) */
118 rtx *reg_equiv_address;
120 /* Element N is the memory slot to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
121 or zero if pseudo reg N is not equivalent to a memory slot. */
122 rtx *reg_equiv_mem;
124 /* Widest width in which each pseudo reg is referred to (via subreg). */
125 static unsigned int *reg_max_ref_width;
127 /* Element N is the list of insns that initialized reg N from its equivalent
128 constant or memory slot. */
129 static rtx *reg_equiv_init;
131 /* Vector to remember old contents of reg_renumber before spilling. */
132 static short *reg_old_renumber;
134 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains the last pseudo regno reloaded
135 into hard register N. If that pseudo reg occupied more than one register,
136 reg_reloaded_contents points to that pseudo for each spill register in
137 use; all of these must remain set for an inheritance to occur. */
138 static int reg_reloaded_contents[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
140 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains the insn for which
141 hard register N was last used. Its contents are significant only
142 when reg_reloaded_valid is set for this register. */
143 static rtx reg_reloaded_insn[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
145 /* Indicate if reg_reloaded_insn / reg_reloaded_contents is valid */
146 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_valid;
147 /* Indicate if the register was dead at the end of the reload.
148 This is only valid if reg_reloaded_contents is set and valid. */
149 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_dead;
151 /* Number of spill-regs so far; number of valid elements of spill_regs. */
152 static int n_spills;
154 /* In parallel with spill_regs, contains REG rtx's for those regs.
155 Holds the last rtx used for any given reg, or 0 if it has never
156 been used for spilling yet. This rtx is reused, provided it has
157 the proper mode. */
158 static rtx spill_reg_rtx[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
160 /* In parallel with spill_regs, contains nonzero for a spill reg
161 that was stored after the last time it was used.
162 The precise value is the insn generated to do the store. */
163 static rtx spill_reg_store[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
165 /* This is the register that was stored with spill_reg_store. This is a
166 copy of reload_out / reload_out_reg when the value was stored; if
167 reload_out is a MEM, spill_reg_stored_to will be set to reload_out_reg. */
168 static rtx spill_reg_stored_to[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
170 /* This table is the inverse mapping of spill_regs:
171 indexed by hard reg number,
172 it contains the position of that reg in spill_regs,
173 or -1 for something that is not in spill_regs.
175 ?!? This is no longer accurate. */
176 static short spill_reg_order[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
178 /* This reg set indicates registers that can't be used as spill registers for
179 the currently processed insn. These are the hard registers which are live
180 during the insn, but not allocated to pseudos, as well as fixed
181 registers. */
182 static HARD_REG_SET bad_spill_regs;
184 /* These are the hard registers that can't be used as spill register for any
185 insn. This includes registers used for user variables and registers that
186 we can't eliminate. A register that appears in this set also can't be used
187 to retry register allocation. */
188 static HARD_REG_SET bad_spill_regs_global;
190 /* Describes order of use of registers for reloading
191 of spilled pseudo-registers. `n_spills' is the number of
192 elements that are actually valid; new ones are added at the end.
194 Both spill_regs and spill_reg_order are used on two occasions:
195 once during find_reload_regs, where they keep track of the spill registers
196 for a single insn, but also during reload_as_needed where they show all
197 the registers ever used by reload. For the latter case, the information
198 is calculated during finish_spills. */
199 static short spill_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
201 /* This vector of reg sets indicates, for each pseudo, which hard registers
202 may not be used for retrying global allocation because the register was
203 formerly spilled from one of them. If we allowed reallocating a pseudo to
204 a register that it was already allocated to, reload might not
205 terminate. */
206 static HARD_REG_SET *pseudo_previous_regs;
208 /* This vector of reg sets indicates, for each pseudo, which hard
209 registers may not be used for retrying global allocation because they
210 are used as spill registers during one of the insns in which the
211 pseudo is live. */
212 static HARD_REG_SET *pseudo_forbidden_regs;
214 /* All hard regs that have been used as spill registers for any insn are
215 marked in this set. */
216 static HARD_REG_SET used_spill_regs;
218 /* Index of last register assigned as a spill register. We allocate in
219 a round-robin fashion. */
220 static int last_spill_reg;
222 /* Nonzero if indirect addressing is supported on the machine; this means
223 that spilling (REG n) does not require reloading it into a register in
224 order to do (MEM (REG n)) or (MEM (PLUS (REG n) (CONST_INT c))). The
225 value indicates the level of indirect addressing supported, e.g., two
226 means that (MEM (MEM (REG n))) is also valid if (REG n) does not get
227 a hard register. */
228 static char spill_indirect_levels;
230 /* Nonzero if indirect addressing is supported when the innermost MEM is
231 of the form (MEM (SYMBOL_REF sym)). It is assumed that the level to
232 which these are valid is the same as spill_indirect_levels, above. */
233 char indirect_symref_ok;
235 /* Nonzero if an address (plus (reg frame_pointer) (reg ...)) is valid. */
236 char double_reg_address_ok;
238 /* Record the stack slot for each spilled hard register. */
239 static rtx spill_stack_slot[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
241 /* Width allocated so far for that stack slot. */
242 static unsigned int spill_stack_slot_width[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
244 /* Record which pseudos needed to be spilled. */
245 static regset_head spilled_pseudos;
247 /* Used for communication between order_regs_for_reload and count_pseudo.
248 Used to avoid counting one pseudo twice. */
249 static regset_head pseudos_counted;
251 /* First uid used by insns created by reload in this function.
252 Used in find_equiv_reg. */
253 int reload_first_uid;
255 /* Flag set by local-alloc or global-alloc if anything is live in
256 a call-clobbered reg across calls. */
257 int caller_save_needed;
259 /* Set to 1 while reload_as_needed is operating.
260 Required by some machines to handle any generated moves differently. */
261 int reload_in_progress = 0;
263 /* These arrays record the insn_code of insns that may be needed to
264 perform input and output reloads of special objects. They provide a
265 place to pass a scratch register. */
266 enum insn_code reload_in_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
267 enum insn_code reload_out_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
269 /* This obstack is used for allocation of rtl during register elimination.
270 The allocated storage can be freed once find_reloads has processed the
271 insn. */
272 struct obstack reload_obstack;
274 /* Points to the beginning of the reload_obstack. All insn_chain structures
275 are allocated first. */
276 char *reload_startobj;
278 /* The point after all insn_chain structures. Used to quickly deallocate
279 memory allocated in copy_reloads during calculate_needs_all_insns. */
280 char *reload_firstobj;
282 /* This points before all local rtl generated by register elimination.
283 Used to quickly free all memory after processing one insn. */
284 static char *reload_insn_firstobj;
286 #define obstack_chunk_alloc xmalloc
287 #define obstack_chunk_free free
289 /* List of insn_chain instructions, one for every insn that reload needs to
290 examine. */
291 struct insn_chain *reload_insn_chain;
293 #ifdef TREE_CODE
294 extern tree current_function_decl;
295 #else
296 extern union tree_node *current_function_decl;
297 #endif
299 /* List of all insns needing reloads. */
300 static struct insn_chain *insns_need_reload;
302 /* This structure is used to record information about register eliminations.
303 Each array entry describes one possible way of eliminating a register
304 in favor of another. If there is more than one way of eliminating a
305 particular register, the most preferred should be specified first. */
307 struct elim_table
309 int from; /* Register number to be eliminated. */
310 int to; /* Register number used as replacement. */
311 int initial_offset; /* Initial difference between values. */
312 int can_eliminate; /* Non-zero if this elimination can be done. */
313 int can_eliminate_previous; /* Value of CAN_ELIMINATE in previous scan over
314 insns made by reload. */
315 int offset; /* Current offset between the two regs. */
316 int previous_offset; /* Offset at end of previous insn. */
317 int ref_outside_mem; /* "to" has been referenced outside a MEM. */
318 rtx from_rtx; /* REG rtx for the register to be eliminated.
319 We cannot simply compare the number since
320 we might then spuriously replace a hard
321 register corresponding to a pseudo
322 assigned to the reg to be eliminated. */
323 rtx to_rtx; /* REG rtx for the replacement. */
326 static struct elim_table *reg_eliminate = 0;
328 /* This is an intermediate structure to initialize the table. It has
329 exactly the members provided by ELIMINABLE_REGS. */
330 static struct elim_table_1
332 int from;
333 int to;
334 } reg_eliminate_1[] =
336 /* If a set of eliminable registers was specified, define the table from it.
337 Otherwise, default to the normal case of the frame pointer being
338 replaced by the stack pointer. */
340 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
341 ELIMINABLE_REGS;
342 #else
343 {{ FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}};
344 #endif
346 #define NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS ARRAY_SIZE (reg_eliminate_1)
348 /* Record the number of pending eliminations that have an offset not equal
349 to their initial offset. If non-zero, we use a new copy of each
350 replacement result in any insns encountered. */
351 int num_not_at_initial_offset;
353 /* Count the number of registers that we may be able to eliminate. */
354 static int num_eliminable;
355 /* And the number of registers that are equivalent to a constant that
356 can be eliminated to frame_pointer / arg_pointer + constant. */
357 static int num_eliminable_invariants;
359 /* For each label, we record the offset of each elimination. If we reach
360 a label by more than one path and an offset differs, we cannot do the
361 elimination. This information is indexed by the number of the label.
362 The first table is an array of flags that records whether we have yet
363 encountered a label and the second table is an array of arrays, one
364 entry in the latter array for each elimination. */
366 static char *offsets_known_at;
367 static int (*offsets_at)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
369 /* Number of labels in the current function. */
371 static int num_labels;
373 static void maybe_fix_stack_asms PARAMS ((void));
374 static void copy_reloads PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *));
375 static void calculate_needs_all_insns PARAMS ((int));
376 static int find_reg PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *, int));
377 static void find_reload_regs PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *));
378 static void select_reload_regs PARAMS ((void));
379 static void delete_caller_save_insns PARAMS ((void));
381 static void spill_failure PARAMS ((rtx, enum reg_class));
382 static void count_spilled_pseudo PARAMS ((int, int, int));
383 static void delete_dead_insn PARAMS ((rtx));
384 static void alter_reg PARAMS ((int, int));
385 static void set_label_offsets PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, int));
386 static void check_eliminable_occurrences PARAMS ((rtx));
387 static void elimination_effects PARAMS ((rtx, enum machine_mode));
388 static int eliminate_regs_in_insn PARAMS ((rtx, int));
389 static void update_eliminable_offsets PARAMS ((void));
390 static void mark_not_eliminable PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, void *));
391 static void set_initial_elim_offsets PARAMS ((void));
392 static void verify_initial_elim_offsets PARAMS ((void));
393 static void set_initial_label_offsets PARAMS ((void));
394 static void set_offsets_for_label PARAMS ((rtx));
395 static void init_elim_table PARAMS ((void));
396 static void update_eliminables PARAMS ((HARD_REG_SET *));
397 static void spill_hard_reg PARAMS ((unsigned int, int));
398 static int finish_spills PARAMS ((int));
399 static void ior_hard_reg_set PARAMS ((HARD_REG_SET *, HARD_REG_SET *));
400 static void scan_paradoxical_subregs PARAMS ((rtx));
401 static void count_pseudo PARAMS ((int));
402 static void order_regs_for_reload PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *));
403 static void reload_as_needed PARAMS ((int));
404 static void forget_old_reloads_1 PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, void *));
405 static int reload_reg_class_lower PARAMS ((const PTR, const PTR));
406 static void mark_reload_reg_in_use PARAMS ((unsigned int, int,
407 enum reload_type,
408 enum machine_mode));
409 static void clear_reload_reg_in_use PARAMS ((unsigned int, int,
410 enum reload_type,
411 enum machine_mode));
412 static int reload_reg_free_p PARAMS ((unsigned int, int,
413 enum reload_type));
414 static int reload_reg_free_for_value_p PARAMS ((int, int, enum reload_type,
415 rtx, rtx, int, int));
416 static int reload_reg_reaches_end_p PARAMS ((unsigned int, int,
417 enum reload_type));
418 static int allocate_reload_reg PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *, int,
419 int));
420 static void failed_reload PARAMS ((rtx, int));
421 static int set_reload_reg PARAMS ((int, int));
422 static void choose_reload_regs_init PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *, rtx *));
423 static void choose_reload_regs PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *));
424 static void merge_assigned_reloads PARAMS ((rtx));
425 static void emit_input_reload_insns PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *,
426 struct reload *, rtx, int));
427 static void emit_output_reload_insns PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *,
428 struct reload *, int));
429 static void do_input_reload PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *,
430 struct reload *, int));
431 static void do_output_reload PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *,
432 struct reload *, int));
433 static void emit_reload_insns PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *));
434 static void delete_output_reload PARAMS ((rtx, int, int));
435 static void delete_address_reloads PARAMS ((rtx, rtx));
436 static void delete_address_reloads_1 PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, rtx));
437 static rtx inc_for_reload PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, rtx, int));
438 static int constraint_accepts_reg_p PARAMS ((const char *, rtx));
439 static void reload_cse_regs_1 PARAMS ((rtx));
440 static int reload_cse_noop_set_p PARAMS ((rtx));
441 static int reload_cse_simplify_set PARAMS ((rtx, rtx));
442 static int reload_cse_simplify_operands PARAMS ((rtx));
443 static void reload_combine PARAMS ((void));
444 static void reload_combine_note_use PARAMS ((rtx *, rtx));
445 static void reload_combine_note_store PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, void *));
446 static void reload_cse_move2add PARAMS ((rtx));
447 static void move2add_note_store PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, void *));
448 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
449 static void add_auto_inc_notes PARAMS ((rtx, rtx));
450 #endif
451 static rtx gen_mode_int PARAMS ((enum machine_mode,
452 HOST_WIDE_INT));
453 static void failed_reload PARAMS ((rtx, int));
454 static int set_reload_reg PARAMS ((int, int));
455 static void reload_cse_delete_noop_set PARAMS ((rtx, rtx));
456 static void reload_cse_simplify PARAMS ((rtx));
457 extern void dump_needs PARAMS ((struct insn_chain *));
459 /* Initialize the reload pass once per compilation. */
461 void
462 init_reload ()
464 register int i;
466 /* Often (MEM (REG n)) is still valid even if (REG n) is put on the stack.
467 Set spill_indirect_levels to the number of levels such addressing is
468 permitted, zero if it is not permitted at all. */
470 register rtx tem
471 = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode,
472 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
473 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode,
474 LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1),
475 GEN_INT (4)));
476 spill_indirect_levels = 0;
478 while (memory_address_p (QImode, tem))
480 spill_indirect_levels++;
481 tem = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, tem);
484 /* See if indirect addressing is valid for (MEM (SYMBOL_REF ...)). */
486 tem = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, "foo"));
487 indirect_symref_ok = memory_address_p (QImode, tem);
489 /* See if reg+reg is a valid (and offsettable) address. */
491 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
493 tem = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
494 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM),
495 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, i));
497 /* This way, we make sure that reg+reg is an offsettable address. */
498 tem = plus_constant (tem, 4);
500 if (memory_address_p (QImode, tem))
502 double_reg_address_ok = 1;
503 break;
507 /* Initialize obstack for our rtl allocation. */
508 gcc_obstack_init (&reload_obstack);
509 reload_startobj = (char *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, 0);
511 INIT_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
512 INIT_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
515 /* List of insn chains that are currently unused. */
516 static struct insn_chain *unused_insn_chains = 0;
518 /* Allocate an empty insn_chain structure. */
519 struct insn_chain *
520 new_insn_chain ()
522 struct insn_chain *c;
524 if (unused_insn_chains == 0)
526 c = (struct insn_chain *)
527 obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, sizeof (struct insn_chain));
528 INIT_REG_SET (&c->live_throughout);
529 INIT_REG_SET (&c->dead_or_set);
531 else
533 c = unused_insn_chains;
534 unused_insn_chains = c->next;
536 c->is_caller_save_insn = 0;
537 c->need_operand_change = 0;
538 c->need_reload = 0;
539 c->need_elim = 0;
540 return c;
543 /* Small utility function to set all regs in hard reg set TO which are
544 allocated to pseudos in regset FROM. */
546 void
547 compute_use_by_pseudos (to, from)
548 HARD_REG_SET *to;
549 regset from;
551 unsigned int regno;
553 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
554 (from, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, regno,
556 int r = reg_renumber[regno];
557 int nregs;
559 if (r < 0)
561 /* reload_combine uses the information from
562 BASIC_BLOCK->global_live_at_start, which might still
563 contain registers that have not actually been allocated
564 since they have an equivalence. */
565 if (! reload_completed)
566 abort ();
568 else
570 nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (r, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (regno));
571 while (nregs-- > 0)
572 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*to, r + nregs);
577 /* Global variables used by reload and its subroutines. */
579 /* Set during calculate_needs if an insn needs register elimination. */
580 static int something_needs_elimination;
581 /* Set during calculate_needs if an insn needs an operand changed. */
582 int something_needs_operands_changed;
584 /* Nonzero means we couldn't get enough spill regs. */
585 static int failure;
587 /* Main entry point for the reload pass.
589 FIRST is the first insn of the function being compiled.
591 GLOBAL nonzero means we were called from global_alloc
592 and should attempt to reallocate any pseudoregs that we
593 displace from hard regs we will use for reloads.
594 If GLOBAL is zero, we do not have enough information to do that,
595 so any pseudo reg that is spilled must go to the stack.
597 Return value is nonzero if reload failed
598 and we must not do any more for this function. */
601 reload (first, global)
602 rtx first;
603 int global;
605 register int i;
606 register rtx insn;
607 register struct elim_table *ep;
609 /* The two pointers used to track the true location of the memory used
610 for label offsets. */
611 char *real_known_ptr = NULL_PTR;
612 int (*real_at_ptr)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
614 /* Make sure even insns with volatile mem refs are recognizable. */
615 init_recog ();
617 failure = 0;
619 reload_firstobj = (char *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, 0);
621 /* Make sure that the last insn in the chain
622 is not something that needs reloading. */
623 emit_note (NULL_PTR, NOTE_INSN_DELETED);
625 /* Enable find_equiv_reg to distinguish insns made by reload. */
626 reload_first_uid = get_max_uid ();
628 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
629 /* Initialize the secondary memory table. */
630 clear_secondary_mem ();
631 #endif
633 /* We don't have a stack slot for any spill reg yet. */
634 memset ((char *) spill_stack_slot, 0, sizeof spill_stack_slot);
635 memset ((char *) spill_stack_slot_width, 0, sizeof spill_stack_slot_width);
637 /* Initialize the save area information for caller-save, in case some
638 are needed. */
639 init_save_areas ();
641 /* Compute which hard registers are now in use
642 as homes for pseudo registers.
643 This is done here rather than (eg) in global_alloc
644 because this point is reached even if not optimizing. */
645 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
646 mark_home_live (i);
648 /* A function that receives a nonlocal goto must save all call-saved
649 registers. */
650 if (current_function_has_nonlocal_label)
651 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
652 if (! call_used_regs[i] && ! fixed_regs[i] && ! LOCAL_REGNO (i))
653 regs_ever_live[i] = 1;
655 /* Find all the pseudo registers that didn't get hard regs
656 but do have known equivalent constants or memory slots.
657 These include parameters (known equivalent to parameter slots)
658 and cse'd or loop-moved constant memory addresses.
660 Record constant equivalents in reg_equiv_constant
661 so they will be substituted by find_reloads.
662 Record memory equivalents in reg_mem_equiv so they can
663 be substituted eventually by altering the REG-rtx's. */
665 reg_equiv_constant = (rtx *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (rtx));
666 reg_equiv_memory_loc = (rtx *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (rtx));
667 reg_equiv_mem = (rtx *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (rtx));
668 reg_equiv_init = (rtx *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (rtx));
669 reg_equiv_address = (rtx *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (rtx));
670 reg_max_ref_width = (unsigned int *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (int));
671 reg_old_renumber = (short *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (short));
672 bcopy ((PTR) reg_renumber, (PTR) reg_old_renumber, max_regno * sizeof (short));
673 pseudo_forbidden_regs
674 = (HARD_REG_SET *) xmalloc (max_regno * sizeof (HARD_REG_SET));
675 pseudo_previous_regs
676 = (HARD_REG_SET *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (HARD_REG_SET));
678 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs_global);
680 /* Look for REG_EQUIV notes; record what each pseudo is equivalent to.
681 Also find all paradoxical subregs and find largest such for each pseudo.
682 On machines with small register classes, record hard registers that
683 are used for user variables. These can never be used for spills.
684 Also look for a "constant" NOTE_INSN_SETJMP. This means that all
685 caller-saved registers must be marked live. */
687 num_eliminable_invariants = 0;
688 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
690 rtx set = single_set (insn);
692 if (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE && CONST_CALL_P (insn)
693 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_SETJMP)
694 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
695 if (! call_used_regs[i])
696 regs_ever_live[i] = 1;
698 if (set != 0 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == REG)
700 rtx note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUIV, NULL_RTX);
701 if (note
702 #ifdef LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P
703 && (! function_invariant_p (XEXP (note, 0))
704 || ! flag_pic
705 || LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (XEXP (note, 0)))
706 #endif
709 rtx x = XEXP (note, 0);
710 i = REGNO (SET_DEST (set));
711 if (i > LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
713 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
715 /* If the operand is a PLUS, the MEM may be shared,
716 so make sure we have an unshared copy here. */
717 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS)
718 x = copy_rtx (x);
720 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = x;
722 else if (function_invariant_p (x))
724 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS)
726 /* This is PLUS of frame pointer and a constant,
727 and might be shared. Unshare it. */
728 reg_equiv_constant[i] = copy_rtx (x);
729 num_eliminable_invariants++;
731 else if (x == frame_pointer_rtx
732 || x == arg_pointer_rtx)
734 reg_equiv_constant[i] = x;
735 num_eliminable_invariants++;
737 else if (LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
738 reg_equiv_constant[i] = x;
739 else
740 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i]
741 = force_const_mem (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)), x);
743 else
744 continue;
746 /* If this register is being made equivalent to a MEM
747 and the MEM is not SET_SRC, the equivalencing insn
748 is one with the MEM as a SET_DEST and it occurs later.
749 So don't mark this insn now. */
750 if (GET_CODE (x) != MEM
751 || rtx_equal_p (SET_SRC (set), x))
752 reg_equiv_init[i]
753 = gen_rtx_INSN_LIST (VOIDmode, insn, reg_equiv_init[i]);
758 /* If this insn is setting a MEM from a register equivalent to it,
759 this is the equivalencing insn. */
760 else if (set && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == MEM
761 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == REG
762 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SET_SRC (set))]
763 && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (set),
764 reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SET_SRC (set))]))
765 reg_equiv_init[REGNO (SET_SRC (set))]
766 = gen_rtx_INSN_LIST (VOIDmode, insn,
767 reg_equiv_init[REGNO (SET_SRC (set))]);
769 if (INSN_P (insn))
770 scan_paradoxical_subregs (PATTERN (insn));
773 init_elim_table ();
775 num_labels = max_label_num () - get_first_label_num ();
777 /* Allocate the tables used to store offset information at labels. */
778 /* We used to use alloca here, but the size of what it would try to
779 allocate would occasionally cause it to exceed the stack limit and
780 cause a core dump. */
781 real_known_ptr = xmalloc (num_labels);
782 real_at_ptr
783 = (int (*)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS])
784 xmalloc (num_labels * NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS * sizeof (int));
786 offsets_known_at = real_known_ptr - get_first_label_num ();
787 offsets_at
788 = (int (*)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]) (real_at_ptr - get_first_label_num ());
790 /* Alter each pseudo-reg rtx to contain its hard reg number.
791 Assign stack slots to the pseudos that lack hard regs or equivalents.
792 Do not touch virtual registers. */
794 for (i = LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1; i < max_regno; i++)
795 alter_reg (i, -1);
797 /* If we have some registers we think can be eliminated, scan all insns to
798 see if there is an insn that sets one of these registers to something
799 other than itself plus a constant. If so, the register cannot be
800 eliminated. Doing this scan here eliminates an extra pass through the
801 main reload loop in the most common case where register elimination
802 cannot be done. */
803 for (insn = first; insn && num_eliminable; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
804 if (GET_CODE (insn) == INSN || GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
805 || GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
806 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), mark_not_eliminable, NULL);
808 maybe_fix_stack_asms ();
810 insns_need_reload = 0;
811 something_needs_elimination = 0;
813 /* Initialize to -1, which means take the first spill register. */
814 last_spill_reg = -1;
816 /* Spill any hard regs that we know we can't eliminate. */
817 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs);
818 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
819 if (! ep->can_eliminate)
820 spill_hard_reg (ep->from, 1);
822 #if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
823 if (frame_pointer_needed)
824 spill_hard_reg (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, 1);
825 #endif
826 finish_spills (global);
828 /* From now on, we may need to generate moves differently. We may also
829 allow modifications of insns which cause them to not be recognized.
830 Any such modifications will be cleaned up during reload itself. */
831 reload_in_progress = 1;
833 /* This loop scans the entire function each go-round
834 and repeats until one repetition spills no additional hard regs. */
835 for (;;)
837 int something_changed;
838 int did_spill;
840 HOST_WIDE_INT starting_frame_size;
842 /* Round size of stack frame to stack_alignment_needed. This must be done
843 here because the stack size may be a part of the offset computation
844 for register elimination, and there might have been new stack slots
845 created in the last iteration of this loop. */
846 if (cfun->stack_alignment_needed)
847 assign_stack_local (BLKmode, 0, cfun->stack_alignment_needed);
849 starting_frame_size = get_frame_size ();
851 set_initial_elim_offsets ();
852 set_initial_label_offsets ();
854 /* For each pseudo register that has an equivalent location defined,
855 try to eliminate any eliminable registers (such as the frame pointer)
856 assuming initial offsets for the replacement register, which
857 is the normal case.
859 If the resulting location is directly addressable, substitute
860 the MEM we just got directly for the old REG.
862 If it is not addressable but is a constant or the sum of a hard reg
863 and constant, it is probably not addressable because the constant is
864 out of range, in that case record the address; we will generate
865 hairy code to compute the address in a register each time it is
866 needed. Similarly if it is a hard register, but one that is not
867 valid as an address register.
869 If the location is not addressable, but does not have one of the
870 above forms, assign a stack slot. We have to do this to avoid the
871 potential of producing lots of reloads if, e.g., a location involves
872 a pseudo that didn't get a hard register and has an equivalent memory
873 location that also involves a pseudo that didn't get a hard register.
875 Perhaps at some point we will improve reload_when_needed handling
876 so this problem goes away. But that's very hairy. */
878 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
879 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[i])
881 rtx x = eliminate_regs (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i], 0, NULL_RTX);
883 if (strict_memory_address_p (GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]),
884 XEXP (x, 0)))
885 reg_equiv_mem[i] = x, reg_equiv_address[i] = 0;
886 else if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 0))
887 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
888 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
889 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
890 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == REG
891 && (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))
892 < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
893 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1))))
894 reg_equiv_address[i] = XEXP (x, 0), reg_equiv_mem[i] = 0;
895 else
897 /* Make a new stack slot. Then indicate that something
898 changed so we go back and recompute offsets for
899 eliminable registers because the allocation of memory
900 below might change some offset. reg_equiv_{mem,address}
901 will be set up for this pseudo on the next pass around
902 the loop. */
903 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = 0;
904 reg_equiv_init[i] = 0;
905 alter_reg (i, -1);
909 if (caller_save_needed)
910 setup_save_areas ();
912 /* If we allocated another stack slot, redo elimination bookkeeping. */
913 if (starting_frame_size != get_frame_size ())
914 continue;
916 if (caller_save_needed)
918 save_call_clobbered_regs ();
919 /* That might have allocated new insn_chain structures. */
920 reload_firstobj = (char *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, 0);
923 calculate_needs_all_insns (global);
925 CLEAR_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
926 did_spill = 0;
928 something_changed = 0;
930 /* If we allocated any new memory locations, make another pass
931 since it might have changed elimination offsets. */
932 if (starting_frame_size != get_frame_size ())
933 something_changed = 1;
936 HARD_REG_SET to_spill;
937 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (to_spill);
938 update_eliminables (&to_spill);
939 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
940 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (to_spill, i))
942 spill_hard_reg (i, 1);
943 did_spill = 1;
945 /* Regardless of the state of spills, if we previously had
946 a register that we thought we could eliminate, but no can
947 not eliminate, we must run another pass.
949 Consider pseudos which have an entry in reg_equiv_* which
950 reference an eliminable register. We must make another pass
951 to update reg_equiv_* so that we do not substitute in the
952 old value from when we thought the elimination could be
953 performed. */
954 something_changed = 1;
958 select_reload_regs ();
959 if (failure)
960 goto failed;
962 if (insns_need_reload != 0 || did_spill)
963 something_changed |= finish_spills (global);
965 if (! something_changed)
966 break;
968 if (caller_save_needed)
969 delete_caller_save_insns ();
971 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_firstobj);
974 /* If global-alloc was run, notify it of any register eliminations we have
975 done. */
976 if (global)
977 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
978 if (ep->can_eliminate)
979 mark_elimination (ep->from, ep->to);
981 /* If a pseudo has no hard reg, delete the insns that made the equivalence.
982 If that insn didn't set the register (i.e., it copied the register to
983 memory), just delete that insn instead of the equivalencing insn plus
984 anything now dead. If we call delete_dead_insn on that insn, we may
985 delete the insn that actually sets the register if the register dies
986 there and that is incorrect. */
988 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
990 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0 && reg_equiv_init[i] != 0)
992 rtx list;
993 for (list = reg_equiv_init[i]; list; list = XEXP (list, 1))
995 rtx equiv_insn = XEXP (list, 0);
996 if (GET_CODE (equiv_insn) == NOTE)
997 continue;
998 if (reg_set_p (regno_reg_rtx[i], PATTERN (equiv_insn)))
999 delete_dead_insn (equiv_insn);
1000 else
1002 PUT_CODE (equiv_insn, NOTE);
1003 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (equiv_insn) = 0;
1004 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (equiv_insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
1010 /* Use the reload registers where necessary
1011 by generating move instructions to move the must-be-register
1012 values into or out of the reload registers. */
1014 if (insns_need_reload != 0 || something_needs_elimination
1015 || something_needs_operands_changed)
1017 int old_frame_size = get_frame_size ();
1019 reload_as_needed (global);
1021 if (old_frame_size != get_frame_size ())
1022 abort ();
1024 if (num_eliminable)
1025 verify_initial_elim_offsets ();
1028 /* If we were able to eliminate the frame pointer, show that it is no
1029 longer live at the start of any basic block. If it ls live by
1030 virtue of being in a pseudo, that pseudo will be marked live
1031 and hence the frame pointer will be known to be live via that
1032 pseudo. */
1034 if (! frame_pointer_needed)
1035 for (i = 0; i < n_basic_blocks; i++)
1036 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (BASIC_BLOCK (i)->global_live_at_start,
1037 HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
1039 /* Come here (with failure set nonzero) if we can't get enough spill regs
1040 and we decide not to abort about it. */
1041 failed:
1043 CLEAR_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
1044 reload_in_progress = 0;
1046 /* Now eliminate all pseudo regs by modifying them into
1047 their equivalent memory references.
1048 The REG-rtx's for the pseudos are modified in place,
1049 so all insns that used to refer to them now refer to memory.
1051 For a reg that has a reg_equiv_address, all those insns
1052 were changed by reloading so that no insns refer to it any longer;
1053 but the DECL_RTL of a variable decl may refer to it,
1054 and if so this causes the debugging info to mention the variable. */
1056 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
1058 rtx addr = 0;
1059 int in_struct = 0;
1060 int is_scalar = 0;
1061 int is_readonly = 0;
1063 if (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i])
1065 in_struct = MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i]);
1066 is_scalar = MEM_SCALAR_P (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i]);
1067 is_readonly = RTX_UNCHANGING_P (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i]);
1070 if (reg_equiv_mem[i])
1071 addr = XEXP (reg_equiv_mem[i], 0);
1073 if (reg_equiv_address[i])
1074 addr = reg_equiv_address[i];
1076 if (addr)
1078 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0)
1080 rtx reg = regno_reg_rtx[i];
1081 PUT_CODE (reg, MEM);
1082 XEXP (reg, 0) = addr;
1083 REG_USERVAR_P (reg) = 0;
1084 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (reg) = is_readonly;
1085 MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (reg) = in_struct;
1086 MEM_SCALAR_P (reg) = is_scalar;
1087 /* We have no alias information about this newly created
1088 MEM. */
1089 MEM_ALIAS_SET (reg) = 0;
1091 else if (reg_equiv_mem[i])
1092 XEXP (reg_equiv_mem[i], 0) = addr;
1096 /* We must set reload_completed now since the cleanup_subreg_operands call
1097 below will re-recognize each insn and reload may have generated insns
1098 which are only valid during and after reload. */
1099 reload_completed = 1;
1101 /* Make a pass over all the insns and delete all USEs which we inserted
1102 only to tag a REG_EQUAL note on them. Remove all REG_DEAD and REG_UNUSED
1103 notes. Delete all CLOBBER insns that don't refer to the return value
1104 and simplify (subreg (reg)) operands. Also remove all REG_RETVAL and
1105 REG_LIBCALL notes since they are no longer useful or accurate. Strip
1106 and regenerate REG_INC notes that may have been moved around. */
1108 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
1109 if (INSN_P (insn))
1111 rtx *pnote;
1113 if ((GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
1114 && find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUAL, NULL_RTX))
1115 || (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
1116 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)) != REG
1117 || ! REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)))))
1119 PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
1120 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
1121 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
1122 continue;
1125 pnote = &REG_NOTES (insn);
1126 while (*pnote != 0)
1128 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_DEAD
1129 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_UNUSED
1130 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_INC
1131 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_RETVAL
1132 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_LIBCALL)
1133 *pnote = XEXP (*pnote, 1);
1134 else
1135 pnote = &XEXP (*pnote, 1);
1138 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
1139 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, PATTERN (insn));
1140 #endif
1142 /* And simplify (subreg (reg)) if it appears as an operand. */
1143 cleanup_subreg_operands (insn);
1146 /* If we are doing stack checking, give a warning if this function's
1147 frame size is larger than we expect. */
1148 if (flag_stack_check && ! STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN)
1150 HOST_WIDE_INT size = get_frame_size () + STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE;
1151 static int verbose_warned = 0;
1153 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1154 if (regs_ever_live[i] && ! fixed_regs[i] && call_used_regs[i])
1155 size += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1157 if (size > STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE)
1159 warning ("frame size too large for reliable stack checking");
1160 if (! verbose_warned)
1162 warning ("try reducing the number of local variables");
1163 verbose_warned = 1;
1168 /* Indicate that we no longer have known memory locations or constants. */
1169 if (reg_equiv_constant)
1170 free (reg_equiv_constant);
1171 reg_equiv_constant = 0;
1172 if (reg_equiv_memory_loc)
1173 free (reg_equiv_memory_loc);
1174 reg_equiv_memory_loc = 0;
1176 if (real_known_ptr)
1177 free (real_known_ptr);
1178 if (real_at_ptr)
1179 free (real_at_ptr);
1181 free (reg_equiv_mem);
1182 free (reg_equiv_init);
1183 free (reg_equiv_address);
1184 free (reg_max_ref_width);
1185 free (reg_old_renumber);
1186 free (pseudo_previous_regs);
1187 free (pseudo_forbidden_regs);
1189 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs);
1190 for (i = 0; i < n_spills; i++)
1191 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs, spill_regs[i]);
1193 /* Free all the insn_chain structures at once. */
1194 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_startobj);
1195 unused_insn_chains = 0;
1197 return failure;
1200 /* Yet another special case. Unfortunately, reg-stack forces people to
1201 write incorrect clobbers in asm statements. These clobbers must not
1202 cause the register to appear in bad_spill_regs, otherwise we'll call
1203 fatal_insn later. We clear the corresponding regnos in the live
1204 register sets to avoid this.
1205 The whole thing is rather sick, I'm afraid. */
1207 static void
1208 maybe_fix_stack_asms ()
1210 #ifdef STACK_REGS
1211 const char *constraints[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
1212 enum machine_mode operand_mode[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
1213 struct insn_chain *chain;
1215 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain != 0; chain = chain->next)
1217 int i, noperands;
1218 HARD_REG_SET clobbered, allowed;
1219 rtx pat;
1221 if (! INSN_P (chain->insn)
1222 || (noperands = asm_noperands (PATTERN (chain->insn))) < 0)
1223 continue;
1224 pat = PATTERN (chain->insn);
1225 if (GET_CODE (pat) != PARALLEL)
1226 continue;
1228 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (clobbered);
1229 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (allowed);
1231 /* First, make a mask of all stack regs that are clobbered. */
1232 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (pat, 0); i++)
1234 rtx t = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
1235 if (GET_CODE (t) == CLOBBER && STACK_REG_P (XEXP (t, 0)))
1236 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (clobbered, REGNO (XEXP (t, 0)));
1239 /* Get the operand values and constraints out of the insn. */
1240 decode_asm_operands (pat, recog_data.operand, recog_data.operand_loc,
1241 constraints, operand_mode);
1243 /* For every operand, see what registers are allowed. */
1244 for (i = 0; i < noperands; i++)
1246 const char *p = constraints[i];
1247 /* For every alternative, we compute the class of registers allowed
1248 for reloading in CLS, and merge its contents into the reg set
1249 ALLOWED. */
1250 int cls = (int) NO_REGS;
1252 for (;;)
1254 char c = *p++;
1256 if (c == '\0' || c == ',' || c == '#')
1258 /* End of one alternative - mark the regs in the current
1259 class, and reset the class. */
1260 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (allowed, reg_class_contents[cls]);
1261 cls = NO_REGS;
1262 if (c == '#')
1263 do {
1264 c = *p++;
1265 } while (c != '\0' && c != ',');
1266 if (c == '\0')
1267 break;
1268 continue;
1271 switch (c)
1273 case '=': case '+': case '*': case '%': case '?': case '!':
1274 case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4': case 'm':
1275 case '<': case '>': case 'V': case 'o': case '&': case 'E':
1276 case 'F': case 's': case 'i': case 'n': case 'X': case 'I':
1277 case 'J': case 'K': case 'L': case 'M': case 'N': case 'O':
1278 case 'P':
1279 break;
1281 case 'p':
1282 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls][(int) BASE_REG_CLASS];
1283 break;
1285 case 'g':
1286 case 'r':
1287 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls][(int) GENERAL_REGS];
1288 break;
1290 default:
1291 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls][(int) REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (c)];
1296 /* Those of the registers which are clobbered, but allowed by the
1297 constraints, must be usable as reload registers. So clear them
1298 out of the life information. */
1299 AND_HARD_REG_SET (allowed, clobbered);
1300 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1301 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (allowed, i))
1303 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&chain->live_throughout, i);
1304 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&chain->dead_or_set, i);
1308 #endif
1311 /* Copy the global variables n_reloads and rld into the corresponding elts
1312 of CHAIN. */
1313 static void
1314 copy_reloads (chain)
1315 struct insn_chain *chain;
1317 chain->n_reloads = n_reloads;
1318 chain->rld
1319 = (struct reload *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack,
1320 n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
1321 memcpy (chain->rld, rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
1322 reload_insn_firstobj = (char *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, 0);
1325 /* Walk the chain of insns, and determine for each whether it needs reloads
1326 and/or eliminations. Build the corresponding insns_need_reload list, and
1327 set something_needs_elimination as appropriate. */
1328 static void
1329 calculate_needs_all_insns (global)
1330 int global;
1332 struct insn_chain **pprev_reload = &insns_need_reload;
1333 struct insn_chain *chain, *next = 0;
1335 something_needs_elimination = 0;
1337 reload_insn_firstobj = (char *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, 0);
1338 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain != 0; chain = next)
1340 rtx insn = chain->insn;
1342 next = chain->next;
1344 /* Clear out the shortcuts. */
1345 chain->n_reloads = 0;
1346 chain->need_elim = 0;
1347 chain->need_reload = 0;
1348 chain->need_operand_change = 0;
1350 /* If this is a label, a JUMP_INSN, or has REG_NOTES (which might
1351 include REG_LABEL), we need to see what effects this has on the
1352 known offsets at labels. */
1354 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL || GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
1355 || (INSN_P (insn) && REG_NOTES (insn) != 0))
1356 set_label_offsets (insn, insn, 0);
1358 if (INSN_P (insn))
1360 rtx old_body = PATTERN (insn);
1361 int old_code = INSN_CODE (insn);
1362 rtx old_notes = REG_NOTES (insn);
1363 int did_elimination = 0;
1364 int operands_changed = 0;
1365 rtx set = single_set (insn);
1367 /* Skip insns that only set an equivalence. */
1368 if (set && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == REG
1369 && reg_renumber[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))] < 0
1370 && reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))])
1371 continue;
1373 /* If needed, eliminate any eliminable registers. */
1374 if (num_eliminable || num_eliminable_invariants)
1375 did_elimination = eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn, 0);
1377 /* Analyze the instruction. */
1378 operands_changed = find_reloads (insn, 0, spill_indirect_levels,
1379 global, spill_reg_order);
1381 /* If a no-op set needs more than one reload, this is likely
1382 to be something that needs input address reloads. We
1383 can't get rid of this cleanly later, and it is of no use
1384 anyway, so discard it now.
1385 We only do this when expensive_optimizations is enabled,
1386 since this complements reload inheritance / output
1387 reload deletion, and it can make debugging harder. */
1388 if (flag_expensive_optimizations && n_reloads > 1)
1390 rtx set = single_set (insn);
1391 if (set
1392 && SET_SRC (set) == SET_DEST (set)
1393 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == REG
1394 && REGNO (SET_SRC (set)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1396 PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
1397 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
1398 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
1399 /* Delete it from the reload chain */
1400 if (chain->prev)
1401 chain->prev->next = next;
1402 else
1403 reload_insn_chain = next;
1404 if (next)
1405 next->prev = chain->prev;
1406 chain->next = unused_insn_chains;
1407 unused_insn_chains = chain;
1408 continue;
1411 if (num_eliminable)
1412 update_eliminable_offsets ();
1414 /* Remember for later shortcuts which insns had any reloads or
1415 register eliminations. */
1416 chain->need_elim = did_elimination;
1417 chain->need_reload = n_reloads > 0;
1418 chain->need_operand_change = operands_changed;
1420 /* Discard any register replacements done. */
1421 if (did_elimination)
1423 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_insn_firstobj);
1424 PATTERN (insn) = old_body;
1425 INSN_CODE (insn) = old_code;
1426 REG_NOTES (insn) = old_notes;
1427 something_needs_elimination = 1;
1430 something_needs_operands_changed |= operands_changed;
1432 if (n_reloads != 0)
1434 copy_reloads (chain);
1435 *pprev_reload = chain;
1436 pprev_reload = &chain->next_need_reload;
1440 *pprev_reload = 0;
1443 /* Comparison function for qsort to decide which of two reloads
1444 should be handled first. *P1 and *P2 are the reload numbers. */
1446 static int
1447 reload_reg_class_lower (r1p, r2p)
1448 const PTR r1p;
1449 const PTR r2p;
1451 register int r1 = *(const short *) r1p, r2 = *(const short *) r2p;
1452 register int t;
1454 /* Consider required reloads before optional ones. */
1455 t = rld[r1].optional - rld[r2].optional;
1456 if (t != 0)
1457 return t;
1459 /* Count all solitary classes before non-solitary ones. */
1460 t = ((reg_class_size[(int) rld[r2].class] == 1)
1461 - (reg_class_size[(int) rld[r1].class] == 1));
1462 if (t != 0)
1463 return t;
1465 /* Aside from solitaires, consider all multi-reg groups first. */
1466 t = rld[r2].nregs - rld[r1].nregs;
1467 if (t != 0)
1468 return t;
1470 /* Consider reloads in order of increasing reg-class number. */
1471 t = (int) rld[r1].class - (int) rld[r2].class;
1472 if (t != 0)
1473 return t;
1475 /* If reloads are equally urgent, sort by reload number,
1476 so that the results of qsort leave nothing to chance. */
1477 return r1 - r2;
1480 /* The cost of spilling each hard reg. */
1481 static int spill_cost[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1483 /* When spilling multiple hard registers, we use SPILL_COST for the first
1484 spilled hard reg and SPILL_ADD_COST for subsequent regs. SPILL_ADD_COST
1485 only the first hard reg for a multi-reg pseudo. */
1486 static int spill_add_cost[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1488 /* Update the spill cost arrays, considering that pseudo REG is live. */
1490 static void
1491 count_pseudo (reg)
1492 int reg;
1494 int n_refs = REG_N_REFS (reg);
1495 int r = reg_renumber[reg];
1496 int nregs;
1498 if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (&pseudos_counted, reg)
1499 || REGNO_REG_SET_P (&spilled_pseudos, reg))
1500 return;
1502 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted, reg);
1504 if (r < 0)
1505 abort ();
1507 spill_add_cost[r] += n_refs;
1509 nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (r, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (reg));
1510 while (nregs-- > 0)
1511 spill_cost[r + nregs] += n_refs;
1514 /* Calculate the SPILL_COST and SPILL_ADD_COST arrays and determine the
1515 contents of BAD_SPILL_REGS for the insn described by CHAIN. */
1517 static void
1518 order_regs_for_reload (chain)
1519 struct insn_chain *chain;
1521 int i;
1522 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos;
1523 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos2;
1525 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, fixed_reg_set);
1527 memset (spill_cost, 0, sizeof spill_cost);
1528 memset (spill_add_cost, 0, sizeof spill_add_cost);
1530 /* Count number of uses of each hard reg by pseudo regs allocated to it
1531 and then order them by decreasing use. First exclude hard registers
1532 that are live in or across this insn. */
1534 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
1535 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2, &chain->dead_or_set);
1536 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos);
1537 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos2);
1539 /* Now find out which pseudos are allocated to it, and update
1540 hard_reg_n_uses. */
1541 CLEAR_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
1543 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1544 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i,
1546 count_pseudo (i);
1548 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1549 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i,
1551 count_pseudo (i);
1553 CLEAR_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
1556 /* Vector of reload-numbers showing the order in which the reloads should
1557 be processed. */
1558 static short reload_order[MAX_RELOADS];
1560 /* This is used to keep track of the spill regs used in one insn. */
1561 static HARD_REG_SET used_spill_regs_local;
1563 /* We decided to spill hard register SPILLED, which has a size of
1564 SPILLED_NREGS. Determine how pseudo REG, which is live during the insn,
1565 is affected. We will add it to SPILLED_PSEUDOS if necessary, and we will
1566 update SPILL_COST/SPILL_ADD_COST. */
1568 static void
1569 count_spilled_pseudo (spilled, spilled_nregs, reg)
1570 int spilled, spilled_nregs, reg;
1572 int r = reg_renumber[reg];
1573 int nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (r, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (reg));
1575 if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (&spilled_pseudos, reg)
1576 || spilled + spilled_nregs <= r || r + nregs <= spilled)
1577 return;
1579 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, reg);
1581 spill_add_cost[r] -= REG_N_REFS (reg);
1582 while (nregs-- > 0)
1583 spill_cost[r + nregs] -= REG_N_REFS (reg);
1586 /* Find reload register to use for reload number ORDER. */
1588 static int
1589 find_reg (chain, order)
1590 struct insn_chain *chain;
1591 int order;
1593 int rnum = reload_order[order];
1594 struct reload *rl = rld + rnum;
1595 int best_cost = INT_MAX;
1596 int best_reg = -1;
1597 unsigned int i, j;
1598 int k;
1599 HARD_REG_SET not_usable;
1600 HARD_REG_SET used_by_other_reload;
1602 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, bad_spill_regs);
1603 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, bad_spill_regs_global);
1604 IOR_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, reg_class_contents[rl->class]);
1606 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_other_reload);
1607 for (k = 0; k < order; k++)
1609 int other = reload_order[k];
1611 if (rld[other].regno >= 0 && reloads_conflict (other, rnum))
1612 for (j = 0; j < rld[other].nregs; j++)
1613 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, rld[other].regno + j);
1616 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1618 unsigned int regno = i;
1620 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (not_usable, regno)
1621 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, regno)
1622 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rl->mode))
1624 int this_cost = spill_cost[regno];
1625 int ok = 1;
1626 unsigned int this_nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, rl->mode);
1628 for (j = 1; j < this_nregs; j++)
1630 this_cost += spill_add_cost[regno + j];
1631 if ((TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (not_usable, regno + j))
1632 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, regno + j))
1633 ok = 0;
1635 if (! ok)
1636 continue;
1637 if (rl->in && GET_CODE (rl->in) == REG && REGNO (rl->in) == regno)
1638 this_cost--;
1639 if (rl->out && GET_CODE (rl->out) == REG && REGNO (rl->out) == regno)
1640 this_cost--;
1641 if (this_cost < best_cost
1642 /* Among registers with equal cost, prefer caller-saved ones, or
1643 use REG_ALLOC_ORDER if it is defined. */
1644 || (this_cost == best_cost
1645 #ifdef REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1646 && (inv_reg_alloc_order[regno]
1647 < inv_reg_alloc_order[best_reg])
1648 #else
1649 && call_used_regs[regno]
1650 && ! call_used_regs[best_reg]
1651 #endif
1654 best_reg = regno;
1655 best_cost = this_cost;
1659 if (best_reg == -1)
1660 return 0;
1662 if (rtl_dump_file)
1663 fprintf (rtl_dump_file, "Using reg %d for reload %d\n", best_reg, rnum);
1665 rl->nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (best_reg, rl->mode);
1666 rl->regno = best_reg;
1668 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1669 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, j,
1671 count_spilled_pseudo (best_reg, rl->nregs, j);
1674 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1675 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, j,
1677 count_spilled_pseudo (best_reg, rl->nregs, j);
1680 for (i = 0; i < rl->nregs; i++)
1682 if (spill_cost[best_reg + i] != 0
1683 || spill_add_cost[best_reg + i] != 0)
1684 abort ();
1685 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs_local, best_reg + i);
1687 return 1;
1690 /* Find more reload regs to satisfy the remaining need of an insn, which
1691 is given by CHAIN.
1692 Do it by ascending class number, since otherwise a reg
1693 might be spilled for a big class and might fail to count
1694 for a smaller class even though it belongs to that class. */
1696 static void
1697 find_reload_regs (chain)
1698 struct insn_chain *chain;
1700 int i;
1702 /* In order to be certain of getting the registers we need,
1703 we must sort the reloads into order of increasing register class.
1704 Then our grabbing of reload registers will parallel the process
1705 that provided the reload registers. */
1706 for (i = 0; i < chain->n_reloads; i++)
1708 /* Show whether this reload already has a hard reg. */
1709 if (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx)
1711 int regno = REGNO (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx);
1712 chain->rld[i].regno = regno;
1713 chain->rld[i].nregs
1714 = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx));
1716 else
1717 chain->rld[i].regno = -1;
1718 reload_order[i] = i;
1721 n_reloads = chain->n_reloads;
1722 memcpy (rld, chain->rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
1724 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs_local);
1726 if (rtl_dump_file)
1727 fprintf (rtl_dump_file, "Spilling for insn %d.\n", INSN_UID (chain->insn));
1729 qsort (reload_order, n_reloads, sizeof (short), reload_reg_class_lower);
1731 /* Compute the order of preference for hard registers to spill. */
1733 order_regs_for_reload (chain);
1735 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
1737 int r = reload_order[i];
1739 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
1740 if ((rld[r].out != 0 || rld[r].in != 0 || rld[r].secondary_p)
1741 && ! rld[r].optional
1742 && rld[r].regno == -1)
1743 if (! find_reg (chain, i))
1745 spill_failure (chain->insn, rld[r].class);
1746 failure = 1;
1747 return;
1751 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs_local);
1752 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs_local);
1754 memcpy (chain->rld, rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
1757 static void
1758 select_reload_regs ()
1760 struct insn_chain *chain;
1762 /* Try to satisfy the needs for each insn. */
1763 for (chain = insns_need_reload; chain != 0;
1764 chain = chain->next_need_reload)
1765 find_reload_regs (chain);
1768 /* Delete all insns that were inserted by emit_caller_save_insns during
1769 this iteration. */
1770 static void
1771 delete_caller_save_insns ()
1773 struct insn_chain *c = reload_insn_chain;
1775 while (c != 0)
1777 while (c != 0 && c->is_caller_save_insn)
1779 struct insn_chain *next = c->next;
1780 rtx insn = c->insn;
1782 if (insn == BLOCK_HEAD (c->block))
1783 BLOCK_HEAD (c->block) = NEXT_INSN (insn);
1784 if (insn == BLOCK_END (c->block))
1785 BLOCK_END (c->block) = PREV_INSN (insn);
1786 if (c == reload_insn_chain)
1787 reload_insn_chain = next;
1789 if (NEXT_INSN (insn) != 0)
1790 PREV_INSN (NEXT_INSN (insn)) = PREV_INSN (insn);
1791 if (PREV_INSN (insn) != 0)
1792 NEXT_INSN (PREV_INSN (insn)) = NEXT_INSN (insn);
1794 if (next)
1795 next->prev = c->prev;
1796 if (c->prev)
1797 c->prev->next = next;
1798 c->next = unused_insn_chains;
1799 unused_insn_chains = c;
1800 c = next;
1802 if (c != 0)
1803 c = c->next;
1807 /* Handle the failure to find a register to spill.
1808 INSN should be one of the insns which needed this particular spill reg. */
1810 static void
1811 spill_failure (insn, class)
1812 rtx insn;
1813 enum reg_class class;
1815 static const char *const reg_class_names[] = REG_CLASS_NAMES;
1816 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
1817 error_for_asm (insn, "Can't find a register in class `%s' while reloading `asm'.",
1818 reg_class_names[class]);
1819 else
1821 error ("Unable to find a register to spill in class `%s'.",
1822 reg_class_names[class]);
1823 fatal_insn ("This is the insn:", insn);
1827 /* Delete an unneeded INSN and any previous insns who sole purpose is loading
1828 data that is dead in INSN. */
1830 static void
1831 delete_dead_insn (insn)
1832 rtx insn;
1834 rtx prev = prev_real_insn (insn);
1835 rtx prev_dest;
1837 /* If the previous insn sets a register that dies in our insn, delete it
1838 too. */
1839 if (prev && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SET
1840 && (prev_dest = SET_DEST (PATTERN (prev)), GET_CODE (prev_dest) == REG)
1841 && reg_mentioned_p (prev_dest, PATTERN (insn))
1842 && find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, REGNO (prev_dest))
1843 && ! side_effects_p (SET_SRC (PATTERN (prev))))
1844 delete_dead_insn (prev);
1846 PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
1847 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
1848 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
1851 /* Modify the home of pseudo-reg I.
1852 The new home is present in reg_renumber[I].
1854 FROM_REG may be the hard reg that the pseudo-reg is being spilled from;
1855 or it may be -1, meaning there is none or it is not relevant.
1856 This is used so that all pseudos spilled from a given hard reg
1857 can share one stack slot. */
1859 static void
1860 alter_reg (i, from_reg)
1861 register int i;
1862 int from_reg;
1864 /* When outputting an inline function, this can happen
1865 for a reg that isn't actually used. */
1866 if (regno_reg_rtx[i] == 0)
1867 return;
1869 /* If the reg got changed to a MEM at rtl-generation time,
1870 ignore it. */
1871 if (GET_CODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]) != REG)
1872 return;
1874 /* Modify the reg-rtx to contain the new hard reg
1875 number or else to contain its pseudo reg number. */
1876 REGNO (regno_reg_rtx[i])
1877 = reg_renumber[i] >= 0 ? reg_renumber[i] : i;
1879 /* If we have a pseudo that is needed but has no hard reg or equivalent,
1880 allocate a stack slot for it. */
1882 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0
1883 && REG_N_REFS (i) > 0
1884 && reg_equiv_constant[i] == 0
1885 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] == 0)
1887 register rtx x;
1888 unsigned int inherent_size = PSEUDO_REGNO_BYTES (i);
1889 unsigned int total_size = MAX (inherent_size, reg_max_ref_width[i]);
1890 int adjust = 0;
1892 /* Each pseudo reg has an inherent size which comes from its own mode,
1893 and a total size which provides room for paradoxical subregs
1894 which refer to the pseudo reg in wider modes.
1896 We can use a slot already allocated if it provides both
1897 enough inherent space and enough total space.
1898 Otherwise, we allocate a new slot, making sure that it has no less
1899 inherent space, and no less total space, then the previous slot. */
1900 if (from_reg == -1)
1902 /* No known place to spill from => no slot to reuse. */
1903 x = assign_stack_local (GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]), total_size,
1904 inherent_size == total_size ? 0 : -1);
1905 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
1906 /* Cancel the big-endian correction done in assign_stack_local.
1907 Get the address of the beginning of the slot.
1908 This is so we can do a big-endian correction unconditionally
1909 below. */
1910 adjust = inherent_size - total_size;
1912 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (x) = RTX_UNCHANGING_P (regno_reg_rtx[i]);
1914 /* Nothing can alias this slot except this pseudo. */
1915 MEM_ALIAS_SET (x) = new_alias_set ();
1918 /* Reuse a stack slot if possible. */
1919 else if (spill_stack_slot[from_reg] != 0
1920 && spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] >= total_size
1921 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]))
1922 >= inherent_size))
1923 x = spill_stack_slot[from_reg];
1925 /* Allocate a bigger slot. */
1926 else
1928 /* Compute maximum size needed, both for inherent size
1929 and for total size. */
1930 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]);
1931 rtx stack_slot;
1933 if (spill_stack_slot[from_reg])
1935 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]))
1936 > inherent_size)
1937 mode = GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]);
1938 if (spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] > total_size)
1939 total_size = spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg];
1942 /* Make a slot with that size. */
1943 x = assign_stack_local (mode, total_size,
1944 inherent_size == total_size ? 0 : -1);
1945 stack_slot = x;
1947 /* All pseudos mapped to this slot can alias each other. */
1948 if (spill_stack_slot[from_reg])
1949 MEM_ALIAS_SET (x) = MEM_ALIAS_SET (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]);
1950 else
1951 MEM_ALIAS_SET (x) = new_alias_set ();
1953 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
1955 /* Cancel the big-endian correction done in assign_stack_local.
1956 Get the address of the beginning of the slot.
1957 This is so we can do a big-endian correction unconditionally
1958 below. */
1959 adjust = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - total_size;
1960 if (adjust)
1961 stack_slot = gen_rtx_MEM (mode_for_size (total_size
1962 * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1963 MODE_INT, 1),
1964 plus_constant (XEXP (x, 0), adjust));
1967 spill_stack_slot[from_reg] = stack_slot;
1968 spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] = total_size;
1971 /* On a big endian machine, the "address" of the slot
1972 is the address of the low part that fits its inherent mode. */
1973 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && inherent_size < total_size)
1974 adjust += (total_size - inherent_size);
1976 /* If we have any adjustment to make, or if the stack slot is the
1977 wrong mode, make a new stack slot. */
1978 if (adjust != 0 || GET_MODE (x) != GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]))
1980 rtx new = gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]),
1981 plus_constant (XEXP (x, 0), adjust));
1983 MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (new, x);
1984 x = new;
1987 /* Save the stack slot for later. */
1988 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = x;
1992 /* Mark the slots in regs_ever_live for the hard regs
1993 used by pseudo-reg number REGNO. */
1995 void
1996 mark_home_live (regno)
1997 int regno;
1999 register int i, lim;
2001 i = reg_renumber[regno];
2002 if (i < 0)
2003 return;
2004 lim = i + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (regno));
2005 while (i < lim)
2006 regs_ever_live[i++] = 1;
2009 /* This function handles the tracking of elimination offsets around branches.
2011 X is a piece of RTL being scanned.
2013 INSN is the insn that it came from, if any.
2015 INITIAL_P is non-zero if we are to set the offset to be the initial
2016 offset and zero if we are setting the offset of the label to be the
2017 current offset. */
2019 static void
2020 set_label_offsets (x, insn, initial_p)
2021 rtx x;
2022 rtx insn;
2023 int initial_p;
2025 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2026 rtx tem;
2027 unsigned int i;
2028 struct elim_table *p;
2030 switch (code)
2032 case LABEL_REF:
2033 if (LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (x))
2034 return;
2036 x = XEXP (x, 0);
2038 /* ... fall through ... */
2040 case CODE_LABEL:
2041 /* If we know nothing about this label, set the desired offsets. Note
2042 that this sets the offset at a label to be the offset before a label
2043 if we don't know anything about the label. This is not correct for
2044 the label after a BARRIER, but is the best guess we can make. If
2045 we guessed wrong, we will suppress an elimination that might have
2046 been possible had we been able to guess correctly. */
2048 if (! offsets_known_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x)])
2050 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
2051 offsets_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x)][i]
2052 = (initial_p ? reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset
2053 : reg_eliminate[i].offset);
2054 offsets_known_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x)] = 1;
2057 /* Otherwise, if this is the definition of a label and it is
2058 preceded by a BARRIER, set our offsets to the known offset of
2059 that label. */
2061 else if (x == insn
2062 && (tem = prev_nonnote_insn (insn)) != 0
2063 && GET_CODE (tem) == BARRIER)
2064 set_offsets_for_label (insn);
2065 else
2066 /* If neither of the above cases is true, compare each offset
2067 with those previously recorded and suppress any eliminations
2068 where the offsets disagree. */
2070 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
2071 if (offsets_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x)][i]
2072 != (initial_p ? reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset
2073 : reg_eliminate[i].offset))
2074 reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate = 0;
2076 return;
2078 case JUMP_INSN:
2079 set_label_offsets (PATTERN (insn), insn, initial_p);
2081 /* ... fall through ... */
2083 case INSN:
2084 case CALL_INSN:
2085 /* Any labels mentioned in REG_LABEL notes can be branched to indirectly
2086 and hence must have all eliminations at their initial offsets. */
2087 for (tem = REG_NOTES (x); tem; tem = XEXP (tem, 1))
2088 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (tem) == REG_LABEL)
2089 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, 1);
2090 return;
2092 case ADDR_VEC:
2093 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2094 /* Each of the labels in the address vector must be at their initial
2095 offsets. We want the first field for ADDR_VEC and the second
2096 field for ADDR_DIFF_VEC. */
2098 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned) XVECLEN (x, code == ADDR_DIFF_VEC); i++)
2099 set_label_offsets (XVECEXP (x, code == ADDR_DIFF_VEC, i),
2100 insn, initial_p);
2101 return;
2103 case SET:
2104 /* We only care about setting PC. If the source is not RETURN,
2105 IF_THEN_ELSE, or a label, disable any eliminations not at
2106 their initial offsets. Similarly if any arm of the IF_THEN_ELSE
2107 isn't one of those possibilities. For branches to a label,
2108 call ourselves recursively.
2110 Note that this can disable elimination unnecessarily when we have
2111 a non-local goto since it will look like a non-constant jump to
2112 someplace in the current function. This isn't a significant
2113 problem since such jumps will normally be when all elimination
2114 pairs are back to their initial offsets. */
2116 if (SET_DEST (x) != pc_rtx)
2117 return;
2119 switch (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)))
2121 case PC:
2122 case RETURN:
2123 return;
2125 case LABEL_REF:
2126 set_label_offsets (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0), insn, initial_p);
2127 return;
2129 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
2130 tem = XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1);
2131 if (GET_CODE (tem) == LABEL_REF)
2132 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, initial_p);
2133 else if (GET_CODE (tem) != PC && GET_CODE (tem) != RETURN)
2134 break;
2136 tem = XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 2);
2137 if (GET_CODE (tem) == LABEL_REF)
2138 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, initial_p);
2139 else if (GET_CODE (tem) != PC && GET_CODE (tem) != RETURN)
2140 break;
2141 return;
2143 default:
2144 break;
2147 /* If we reach here, all eliminations must be at their initial
2148 offset because we are doing a jump to a variable address. */
2149 for (p = reg_eliminate; p < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; p++)
2150 if (p->offset != p->initial_offset)
2151 p->can_eliminate = 0;
2152 break;
2154 default:
2155 break;
2159 /* Scan X and replace any eliminable registers (such as fp) with a
2160 replacement (such as sp), plus an offset.
2162 MEM_MODE is the mode of an enclosing MEM. We need this to know how
2163 much to adjust a register for, e.g., PRE_DEC. Also, if we are inside a
2164 MEM, we are allowed to replace a sum of a register and the constant zero
2165 with the register, which we cannot do outside a MEM. In addition, we need
2166 to record the fact that a register is referenced outside a MEM.
2168 If INSN is an insn, it is the insn containing X. If we replace a REG
2169 in a SET_DEST with an equivalent MEM and INSN is non-zero, write a
2170 CLOBBER of the pseudo after INSN so find_equiv_regs will know that
2171 the REG is being modified.
2173 Alternatively, INSN may be a note (an EXPR_LIST or INSN_LIST).
2174 That's used when we eliminate in expressions stored in notes.
2175 This means, do not set ref_outside_mem even if the reference
2176 is outside of MEMs.
2178 REG_EQUIV_MEM and REG_EQUIV_ADDRESS contain address that have had
2179 replacements done assuming all offsets are at their initial values. If
2180 they are not, or if REG_EQUIV_ADDRESS is nonzero for a pseudo we
2181 encounter, return the actual location so that find_reloads will do
2182 the proper thing. */
2185 eliminate_regs (x, mem_mode, insn)
2186 rtx x;
2187 enum machine_mode mem_mode;
2188 rtx insn;
2190 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2191 struct elim_table *ep;
2192 int regno;
2193 rtx new;
2194 int i, j;
2195 const char *fmt;
2196 int copied = 0;
2198 if (! current_function_decl)
2199 return x;
2201 switch (code)
2203 case CONST_INT:
2204 case CONST_DOUBLE:
2205 case CONST:
2206 case SYMBOL_REF:
2207 case CODE_LABEL:
2208 case PC:
2209 case CC0:
2210 case ASM_INPUT:
2211 case ADDR_VEC:
2212 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2213 case RETURN:
2214 return x;
2216 case ADDRESSOF:
2217 /* This is only for the benefit of the debugging backends, which call
2218 eliminate_regs on DECL_RTL; any ADDRESSOFs in the actual insns are
2219 removed after CSE. */
2220 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), 0, insn);
2221 if (GET_CODE (new) == MEM)
2222 return XEXP (new, 0);
2223 return x;
2225 case REG:
2226 regno = REGNO (x);
2228 /* First handle the case where we encounter a bare register that
2229 is eliminable. Replace it with a PLUS. */
2230 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2232 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2233 ep++)
2234 if (ep->from_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
2235 return plus_constant (ep->to_rtx, ep->previous_offset);
2238 else if (reg_renumber[regno] < 0 && reg_equiv_constant
2239 && reg_equiv_constant[regno]
2240 && ! CONSTANT_P (reg_equiv_constant[regno]))
2241 return eliminate_regs (copy_rtx (reg_equiv_constant[regno]),
2242 mem_mode, insn);
2243 return x;
2245 /* You might think handling MINUS in a manner similar to PLUS is a
2246 good idea. It is not. It has been tried multiple times and every
2247 time the change has had to have been reverted.
2249 Other parts of reload know a PLUS is special (gen_reload for example)
2250 and require special code to handle code a reloaded PLUS operand.
2252 Also consider backends where the flags register is clobbered by a
2253 MINUS, but we can emit a PLUS that does not clobber flags (ia32,
2254 lea instruction comes to mind). If we try to reload a MINUS, we
2255 may kill the flags register that was holding a useful value.
2257 So, please before trying to handle MINUS, consider reload as a
2258 whole instead of this little section as well as the backend issues. */
2259 case PLUS:
2260 /* If this is the sum of an eliminable register and a constant, rework
2261 the sum. */
2262 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
2263 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2264 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
2266 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2267 ep++)
2268 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0) && ep->can_eliminate)
2270 /* The only time we want to replace a PLUS with a REG (this
2271 occurs when the constant operand of the PLUS is the negative
2272 of the offset) is when we are inside a MEM. We won't want
2273 to do so at other times because that would change the
2274 structure of the insn in a way that reload can't handle.
2275 We special-case the commonest situation in
2276 eliminate_regs_in_insn, so just replace a PLUS with a
2277 PLUS here, unless inside a MEM. */
2278 if (mem_mode != 0 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
2279 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) == - ep->previous_offset)
2280 return ep->to_rtx;
2281 else
2282 return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, ep->to_rtx,
2283 plus_constant (XEXP (x, 1),
2284 ep->previous_offset));
2287 /* If the register is not eliminable, we are done since the other
2288 operand is a constant. */
2289 return x;
2292 /* If this is part of an address, we want to bring any constant to the
2293 outermost PLUS. We will do this by doing register replacement in
2294 our operands and seeing if a constant shows up in one of them.
2296 Note that there is no risk of modifying the structure of the insn,
2297 since we only get called for its operands, thus we are either
2298 modifying the address inside a MEM, or something like an address
2299 operand of a load-address insn. */
2302 rtx new0 = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn);
2303 rtx new1 = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn);
2305 if (new0 != XEXP (x, 0) || new1 != XEXP (x, 1))
2307 /* If one side is a PLUS and the other side is a pseudo that
2308 didn't get a hard register but has a reg_equiv_constant,
2309 we must replace the constant here since it may no longer
2310 be in the position of any operand. */
2311 if (GET_CODE (new0) == PLUS && GET_CODE (new1) == REG
2312 && REGNO (new1) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2313 && reg_renumber[REGNO (new1)] < 0
2314 && reg_equiv_constant != 0
2315 && reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new1)] != 0)
2316 new1 = reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new1)];
2317 else if (GET_CODE (new1) == PLUS && GET_CODE (new0) == REG
2318 && REGNO (new0) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2319 && reg_renumber[REGNO (new0)] < 0
2320 && reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new0)] != 0)
2321 new0 = reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new0)];
2323 new = form_sum (new0, new1);
2325 /* As above, if we are not inside a MEM we do not want to
2326 turn a PLUS into something else. We might try to do so here
2327 for an addition of 0 if we aren't optimizing. */
2328 if (! mem_mode && GET_CODE (new) != PLUS)
2329 return gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (x), new, const0_rtx);
2330 else
2331 return new;
2334 return x;
2336 case MULT:
2337 /* If this is the product of an eliminable register and a
2338 constant, apply the distribute law and move the constant out
2339 so that we have (plus (mult ..) ..). This is needed in order
2340 to keep load-address insns valid. This case is pathological.
2341 We ignore the possibility of overflow here. */
2342 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
2343 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2344 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
2345 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2346 ep++)
2347 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0) && ep->can_eliminate)
2349 if (! mem_mode
2350 /* Refs inside notes don't count for this purpose. */
2351 && ! (insn != 0 && (GET_CODE (insn) == EXPR_LIST
2352 || GET_CODE (insn) == INSN_LIST)))
2353 ep->ref_outside_mem = 1;
2355 return
2356 plus_constant (gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, ep->to_rtx, XEXP (x, 1)),
2357 ep->previous_offset * INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)));
2360 /* ... fall through ... */
2362 case CALL:
2363 case COMPARE:
2364 /* See comments before PLUS about handling MINUS. */
2365 case MINUS:
2366 case DIV: case UDIV:
2367 case MOD: case UMOD:
2368 case AND: case IOR: case XOR:
2369 case ROTATERT: case ROTATE:
2370 case ASHIFTRT: case LSHIFTRT: case ASHIFT:
2371 case NE: case EQ:
2372 case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU:
2373 case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU:
2375 rtx new0 = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn);
2376 rtx new1
2377 = XEXP (x, 1) ? eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn) : 0;
2379 if (new0 != XEXP (x, 0) || new1 != XEXP (x, 1))
2380 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, GET_MODE (x), new0, new1);
2382 return x;
2384 case EXPR_LIST:
2385 /* If we have something in XEXP (x, 0), the usual case, eliminate it. */
2386 if (XEXP (x, 0))
2388 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn);
2389 if (new != XEXP (x, 0))
2391 /* If this is a REG_DEAD note, it is not valid anymore.
2392 Using the eliminated version could result in creating a
2393 REG_DEAD note for the stack or frame pointer. */
2394 if (GET_MODE (x) == REG_DEAD)
2395 return (XEXP (x, 1)
2396 ? eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn)
2397 : NULL_RTX);
2399 x = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (x), new, XEXP (x, 1));
2403 /* ... fall through ... */
2405 case INSN_LIST:
2406 /* Now do eliminations in the rest of the chain. If this was
2407 an EXPR_LIST, this might result in allocating more memory than is
2408 strictly needed, but it simplifies the code. */
2409 if (XEXP (x, 1))
2411 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn);
2412 if (new != XEXP (x, 1))
2413 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (x), GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0), new);
2415 return x;
2417 case PRE_INC:
2418 case POST_INC:
2419 case PRE_DEC:
2420 case POST_DEC:
2421 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
2422 case NEG: case NOT:
2423 case SIGN_EXTEND: case ZERO_EXTEND:
2424 case TRUNCATE: case FLOAT_EXTEND: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
2425 case FLOAT: case FIX:
2426 case UNSIGNED_FIX: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
2427 case ABS:
2428 case SQRT:
2429 case FFS:
2430 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn);
2431 if (new != XEXP (x, 0))
2432 return gen_rtx_fmt_e (code, GET_MODE (x), new);
2433 return x;
2435 case SUBREG:
2436 /* Similar to above processing, but preserve SUBREG_WORD.
2437 Convert (subreg (mem)) to (mem) if not paradoxical.
2438 Also, if we have a non-paradoxical (subreg (pseudo)) and the
2439 pseudo didn't get a hard reg, we must replace this with the
2440 eliminated version of the memory location because push_reloads
2441 may do the replacement in certain circumstances. */
2442 if (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x)) == REG
2443 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
2444 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
2445 && reg_equiv_memory_loc != 0
2446 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))] != 0)
2448 new = SUBREG_REG (x);
2450 else
2451 new = eliminate_regs (SUBREG_REG (x), mem_mode, insn);
2453 if (new != XEXP (x, 0))
2455 int x_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x));
2456 int new_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (new));
2458 if (GET_CODE (new) == MEM
2459 && ((x_size < new_size
2460 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
2461 /* On these machines, combine can create rtl of the form
2462 (set (subreg:m1 (reg:m2 R) 0) ...)
2463 where m1 < m2, and expects something interesting to
2464 happen to the entire word. Moreover, it will use the
2465 (reg:m2 R) later, expecting all bits to be preserved.
2466 So if the number of words is the same, preserve the
2467 subreg so that push_reloads can see it. */
2468 && ! ((x_size-1)/UNITS_PER_WORD == (new_size-1)/UNITS_PER_WORD)
2469 #endif
2471 || (x_size == new_size))
2474 int offset = SUBREG_WORD (x) * UNITS_PER_WORD;
2475 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
2477 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
2478 offset += (MIN (UNITS_PER_WORD,
2479 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (new)))
2480 - MIN (UNITS_PER_WORD, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)));
2482 PUT_MODE (new, mode);
2483 XEXP (new, 0) = plus_constant (XEXP (new, 0), offset);
2484 return new;
2486 else
2487 return gen_rtx_SUBREG (GET_MODE (x), new, SUBREG_WORD (x));
2490 return x;
2492 case MEM:
2493 /* This is only for the benefit of the debugging backends, which call
2494 eliminate_regs on DECL_RTL; any ADDRESSOFs in the actual insns are
2495 removed after CSE. */
2496 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == ADDRESSOF)
2497 return eliminate_regs (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), 0, insn);
2499 /* Our only special processing is to pass the mode of the MEM to our
2500 recursive call and copy the flags. While we are here, handle this
2501 case more efficiently. */
2502 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x), insn);
2503 if (new != XEXP (x, 0))
2505 new = gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (x), new);
2506 MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (new, x);
2507 return new;
2509 else
2510 return x;
2512 case USE:
2513 case CLOBBER:
2514 case ASM_OPERANDS:
2515 case SET:
2516 abort ();
2518 default:
2519 break;
2522 /* Process each of our operands recursively. If any have changed, make a
2523 copy of the rtx. */
2524 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
2525 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
2527 if (*fmt == 'e')
2529 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, i), mem_mode, insn);
2530 if (new != XEXP (x, i) && ! copied)
2532 rtx new_x = rtx_alloc (code);
2533 bcopy ((char *) x, (char *) new_x,
2534 (sizeof (*new_x) - sizeof (new_x->fld)
2535 + sizeof (new_x->fld[0]) * GET_RTX_LENGTH (code)));
2536 x = new_x;
2537 copied = 1;
2539 XEXP (x, i) = new;
2541 else if (*fmt == 'E')
2543 int copied_vec = 0;
2544 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
2546 new = eliminate_regs (XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode, insn);
2547 if (new != XVECEXP (x, i, j) && ! copied_vec)
2549 rtvec new_v = gen_rtvec_v (XVECLEN (x, i),
2550 XVEC (x, i)->elem);
2551 if (! copied)
2553 rtx new_x = rtx_alloc (code);
2554 bcopy ((char *) x, (char *) new_x,
2555 (sizeof (*new_x) - sizeof (new_x->fld)
2556 + (sizeof (new_x->fld[0])
2557 * GET_RTX_LENGTH (code))));
2558 x = new_x;
2559 copied = 1;
2561 XVEC (x, i) = new_v;
2562 copied_vec = 1;
2564 XVECEXP (x, i, j) = new;
2569 return x;
2572 /* Scan rtx X for modifications of elimination target registers. Update
2573 the table of eliminables to reflect the changed state. MEM_MODE is
2574 the mode of an enclosing MEM rtx, or VOIDmode if not within a MEM. */
2576 static void
2577 elimination_effects (x, mem_mode)
2578 rtx x;
2579 enum machine_mode mem_mode;
2582 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2583 struct elim_table *ep;
2584 int regno;
2585 int i, j;
2586 const char *fmt;
2588 switch (code)
2590 case CONST_INT:
2591 case CONST_DOUBLE:
2592 case CONST:
2593 case SYMBOL_REF:
2594 case CODE_LABEL:
2595 case PC:
2596 case CC0:
2597 case ASM_INPUT:
2598 case ADDR_VEC:
2599 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2600 case RETURN:
2601 return;
2603 case ADDRESSOF:
2604 abort ();
2606 case REG:
2607 regno = REGNO (x);
2609 /* First handle the case where we encounter a bare register that
2610 is eliminable. Replace it with a PLUS. */
2611 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2613 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2614 ep++)
2615 if (ep->from_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
2617 if (! mem_mode)
2618 ep->ref_outside_mem = 1;
2619 return;
2623 else if (reg_renumber[regno] < 0 && reg_equiv_constant
2624 && reg_equiv_constant[regno]
2625 && ! CONSTANT_P (reg_equiv_constant[regno]))
2626 elimination_effects (reg_equiv_constant[regno], mem_mode);
2627 return;
2629 case PRE_INC:
2630 case POST_INC:
2631 case PRE_DEC:
2632 case POST_DEC:
2633 case POST_MODIFY:
2634 case PRE_MODIFY:
2635 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2636 if (ep->to_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
2638 int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mem_mode);
2640 /* If more bytes than MEM_MODE are pushed, account for them. */
2641 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
2642 if (ep->to_rtx == stack_pointer_rtx)
2643 size = PUSH_ROUNDING (size);
2644 #endif
2645 if (code == PRE_DEC || code == POST_DEC)
2646 ep->offset += size;
2647 else if (code == PRE_INC || code == POST_INC)
2648 ep->offset -= size;
2649 else if ((code == PRE_MODIFY || code == POST_MODIFY)
2650 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == PLUS
2651 && XEXP (x, 0) == XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0)
2652 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1)))
2653 ep->offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1));
2656 /* These two aren't unary operators. */
2657 if (code == POST_MODIFY || code == PRE_MODIFY)
2658 break;
2660 /* Fall through to generic unary operation case. */
2661 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
2662 case NEG: case NOT:
2663 case SIGN_EXTEND: case ZERO_EXTEND:
2664 case TRUNCATE: case FLOAT_EXTEND: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
2665 case FLOAT: case FIX:
2666 case UNSIGNED_FIX: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
2667 case ABS:
2668 case SQRT:
2669 case FFS:
2670 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
2671 return;
2673 case SUBREG:
2674 if (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x)) == REG
2675 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
2676 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
2677 && reg_equiv_memory_loc != 0
2678 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))] != 0)
2679 return;
2681 elimination_effects (SUBREG_REG (x), mem_mode);
2682 return;
2684 case USE:
2685 /* If using a register that is the source of an eliminate we still
2686 think can be performed, note it cannot be performed since we don't
2687 know how this register is used. */
2688 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2689 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
2690 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
2692 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
2693 return;
2695 case CLOBBER:
2696 /* If clobbering a register that is the replacement register for an
2697 elimination we still think can be performed, note that it cannot
2698 be performed. Otherwise, we need not be concerned about it. */
2699 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2700 if (ep->to_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
2701 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
2703 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
2704 return;
2706 case SET:
2707 /* Check for setting a register that we know about. */
2708 if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == REG)
2710 /* See if this is setting the replacement register for an
2711 elimination.
2713 If DEST is the hard frame pointer, we do nothing because we
2714 assume that all assignments to the frame pointer are for
2715 non-local gotos and are being done at a time when they are valid
2716 and do not disturb anything else. Some machines want to
2717 eliminate a fake argument pointer (or even a fake frame pointer)
2718 with either the real frame or the stack pointer. Assignments to
2719 the hard frame pointer must not prevent this elimination. */
2721 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2722 ep++)
2723 if (ep->to_rtx == SET_DEST (x)
2724 && SET_DEST (x) != hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2726 /* If it is being incremented, adjust the offset. Otherwise,
2727 this elimination can't be done. */
2728 rtx src = SET_SRC (x);
2730 if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
2731 && XEXP (src, 0) == SET_DEST (x)
2732 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
2733 ep->offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2734 else
2735 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
2739 elimination_effects (SET_DEST (x), 0);
2740 elimination_effects (SET_SRC (x), 0);
2741 return;
2743 case MEM:
2744 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == ADDRESSOF)
2745 abort ();
2747 /* Our only special processing is to pass the mode of the MEM to our
2748 recursive call. */
2749 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x));
2750 return;
2752 default:
2753 break;
2756 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
2757 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
2759 if (*fmt == 'e')
2760 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, i), mem_mode);
2761 else if (*fmt == 'E')
2762 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
2763 elimination_effects (XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode);
2767 /* Descend through rtx X and verify that no references to eliminable registers
2768 remain. If any do remain, mark the involved register as not
2769 eliminable. */
2771 static void
2772 check_eliminable_occurrences (x)
2773 rtx x;
2775 const char *fmt;
2776 int i;
2777 enum rtx_code code;
2779 if (x == 0)
2780 return;
2782 code = GET_CODE (x);
2784 if (code == REG && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2786 struct elim_table *ep;
2788 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2789 if (ep->from_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
2790 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
2791 return;
2794 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
2795 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
2797 if (*fmt == 'e')
2798 check_eliminable_occurrences (XEXP (x, i));
2799 else if (*fmt == 'E')
2801 int j;
2802 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
2803 check_eliminable_occurrences (XVECEXP (x, i, j));
2808 /* Scan INSN and eliminate all eliminable registers in it.
2810 If REPLACE is nonzero, do the replacement destructively. Also
2811 delete the insn as dead it if it is setting an eliminable register.
2813 If REPLACE is zero, do all our allocations in reload_obstack.
2815 If no eliminations were done and this insn doesn't require any elimination
2816 processing (these are not identical conditions: it might be updating sp,
2817 but not referencing fp; this needs to be seen during reload_as_needed so
2818 that the offset between fp and sp can be taken into consideration), zero
2819 is returned. Otherwise, 1 is returned. */
2821 static int
2822 eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn, replace)
2823 rtx insn;
2824 int replace;
2826 int icode = recog_memoized (insn);
2827 rtx old_body = PATTERN (insn);
2828 int insn_is_asm = asm_noperands (old_body) >= 0;
2829 rtx old_set = single_set (insn);
2830 rtx new_body;
2831 int val = 0;
2832 int i, any_changes;
2833 rtx substed_operand[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
2834 rtx orig_operand[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
2835 struct elim_table *ep;
2837 if (! insn_is_asm && icode < 0)
2839 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
2840 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
2841 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ADDR_VEC
2842 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC
2843 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ASM_INPUT)
2844 return 0;
2845 abort ();
2848 if (old_set != 0 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (old_set)) == REG
2849 && REGNO (SET_DEST (old_set)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2851 /* Check for setting an eliminable register. */
2852 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2853 if (ep->from_rtx == SET_DEST (old_set) && ep->can_eliminate)
2855 #if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2856 /* If this is setting the frame pointer register to the
2857 hardware frame pointer register and this is an elimination
2858 that will be done (tested above), this insn is really
2859 adjusting the frame pointer downward to compensate for
2860 the adjustment done before a nonlocal goto. */
2861 if (ep->from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2862 && ep->to == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
2864 rtx src = SET_SRC (old_set);
2865 int offset = 0, ok = 0;
2866 rtx prev_insn, prev_set;
2868 if (src == ep->to_rtx)
2869 offset = 0, ok = 1;
2870 else if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
2871 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == CONST_INT
2872 && XEXP (src, 1) == ep->to_rtx)
2873 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 0)), ok = 1;
2874 else if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
2875 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT
2876 && XEXP (src, 0) == ep->to_rtx)
2877 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1)), ok = 1;
2878 else if ((prev_insn = prev_nonnote_insn (insn)) != 0
2879 && (prev_set = single_set (prev_insn)) != 0
2880 && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (prev_set), src))
2882 src = SET_SRC (prev_set);
2883 if (src == ep->to_rtx)
2884 offset = 0, ok = 1;
2885 else if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
2886 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == CONST_INT
2887 && XEXP (src, 1) == ep->to_rtx)
2888 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 0)), ok = 1;
2889 else if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
2890 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT
2891 && XEXP (src, 0) == ep->to_rtx)
2892 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1)), ok = 1;
2895 if (ok)
2897 if (replace)
2899 rtx src
2900 = plus_constant (ep->to_rtx, offset - ep->offset);
2902 /* First see if this insn remains valid when we
2903 make the change. If not, keep the INSN_CODE
2904 the same and let reload fit it up. */
2905 validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (old_set), src, 1);
2906 validate_change (insn, &SET_DEST (old_set),
2907 ep->to_rtx, 1);
2908 if (! apply_change_group ())
2910 SET_SRC (old_set) = src;
2911 SET_DEST (old_set) = ep->to_rtx;
2915 val = 1;
2916 goto done;
2919 #endif
2921 /* In this case this insn isn't serving a useful purpose. We
2922 will delete it in reload_as_needed once we know that this
2923 elimination is, in fact, being done.
2925 If REPLACE isn't set, we can't delete this insn, but needn't
2926 process it since it won't be used unless something changes. */
2927 if (replace)
2929 delete_dead_insn (insn);
2930 return 1;
2932 val = 1;
2933 goto done;
2937 /* We allow one special case which happens to work on all machines we
2938 currently support: a single set with the source being a PLUS of an
2939 eliminable register and a constant. */
2940 if (old_set
2941 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == PLUS
2942 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 0)) == REG
2943 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 1)) == CONST_INT
2944 && REGNO (XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2946 rtx reg = XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 0);
2947 int offset = INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 1));
2949 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2950 if (ep->from_rtx == reg && ep->can_eliminate)
2952 offset += ep->offset;
2954 if (offset == 0)
2956 int num_clobbers;
2957 /* We assume here that if we need a PARALLEL with
2958 CLOBBERs for this assignment, we can do with the
2959 MATCH_SCRATCHes that add_clobbers allocates.
2960 There's not much we can do if that doesn't work. */
2961 PATTERN (insn) = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
2962 SET_DEST (old_set),
2963 ep->to_rtx);
2964 num_clobbers = 0;
2965 INSN_CODE (insn) = recog (PATTERN (insn), insn, &num_clobbers);
2966 if (num_clobbers)
2968 rtvec vec = rtvec_alloc (num_clobbers + 1);
2970 vec->elem[0] = PATTERN (insn);
2971 PATTERN (insn) = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, vec);
2972 add_clobbers (PATTERN (insn), INSN_CODE (insn));
2974 if (INSN_CODE (insn) < 0)
2975 abort ();
2977 else
2979 new_body = old_body;
2980 if (! replace)
2982 new_body = copy_insn (old_body);
2983 if (REG_NOTES (insn))
2984 REG_NOTES (insn) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn));
2986 PATTERN (insn) = new_body;
2987 old_set = single_set (insn);
2989 XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 0) = ep->to_rtx;
2990 XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 1) = GEN_INT (offset);
2992 val = 1;
2993 /* This can't have an effect on elimination offsets, so skip right
2994 to the end. */
2995 goto done;
2999 /* Determine the effects of this insn on elimination offsets. */
3000 elimination_effects (old_body, 0);
3002 /* Eliminate all eliminable registers occurring in operands that
3003 can be handled by reload. */
3004 extract_insn (insn);
3005 any_changes = 0;
3006 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3008 orig_operand[i] = recog_data.operand[i];
3009 substed_operand[i] = recog_data.operand[i];
3011 /* For an asm statement, every operand is eliminable. */
3012 if (insn_is_asm || insn_data[icode].operand[i].eliminable)
3014 /* Check for setting a register that we know about. */
3015 if (recog_data.operand_type[i] != OP_IN
3016 && GET_CODE (orig_operand[i]) == REG)
3018 /* If we are assigning to a register that can be eliminated, it
3019 must be as part of a PARALLEL, since the code above handles
3020 single SETs. We must indicate that we can no longer
3021 eliminate this reg. */
3022 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
3023 ep++)
3024 if (ep->from_rtx == orig_operand[i] && ep->can_eliminate)
3025 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3028 substed_operand[i] = eliminate_regs (recog_data.operand[i], 0,
3029 replace ? insn : NULL_RTX);
3030 if (substed_operand[i] != orig_operand[i])
3031 val = any_changes = 1;
3032 /* Terminate the search in check_eliminable_occurrences at
3033 this point. */
3034 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = 0;
3036 /* If an output operand changed from a REG to a MEM and INSN is an
3037 insn, write a CLOBBER insn. */
3038 if (recog_data.operand_type[i] != OP_IN
3039 && GET_CODE (orig_operand[i]) == REG
3040 && GET_CODE (substed_operand[i]) == MEM
3041 && replace)
3042 emit_insn_after (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, orig_operand[i]),
3043 insn);
3047 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3048 *recog_data.dup_loc[i]
3049 = *recog_data.operand_loc[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3051 /* If any eliminable remain, they aren't eliminable anymore. */
3052 check_eliminable_occurrences (old_body);
3054 /* Substitute the operands; the new values are in the substed_operand
3055 array. */
3056 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3057 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = substed_operand[i];
3058 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3059 *recog_data.dup_loc[i] = substed_operand[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3061 /* If we are replacing a body that was a (set X (plus Y Z)), try to
3062 re-recognize the insn. We do this in case we had a simple addition
3063 but now can do this as a load-address. This saves an insn in this
3064 common case.
3065 If re-recognition fails, the old insn code number will still be used,
3066 and some register operands may have changed into PLUS expressions.
3067 These will be handled by find_reloads by loading them into a register
3068 again. */
3070 if (val)
3072 /* If we aren't replacing things permanently and we changed something,
3073 make another copy to ensure that all the RTL is new. Otherwise
3074 things can go wrong if find_reload swaps commutative operands
3075 and one is inside RTL that has been copied while the other is not. */
3076 new_body = old_body;
3077 if (! replace)
3079 new_body = copy_insn (old_body);
3080 if (REG_NOTES (insn))
3081 REG_NOTES (insn) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn));
3083 PATTERN (insn) = new_body;
3085 /* If we had a move insn but now we don't, rerecognize it. This will
3086 cause spurious re-recognition if the old move had a PARALLEL since
3087 the new one still will, but we can't call single_set without
3088 having put NEW_BODY into the insn and the re-recognition won't
3089 hurt in this rare case. */
3090 /* ??? Why this huge if statement - why don't we just rerecognize the
3091 thing always? */
3092 if (! insn_is_asm
3093 && old_set != 0
3094 && ((GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == REG
3095 && (GET_CODE (new_body) != SET
3096 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (new_body)) != REG))
3097 /* If this was a load from or store to memory, compare
3098 the MEM in recog_data.operand to the one in the insn.
3099 If they are not equal, then rerecognize the insn. */
3100 || (old_set != 0
3101 && ((GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == MEM
3102 && SET_SRC (old_set) != recog_data.operand[1])
3103 || (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (old_set)) == MEM
3104 && SET_DEST (old_set) != recog_data.operand[0])))
3105 /* If this was an add insn before, rerecognize. */
3106 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == PLUS))
3108 int new_icode = recog (PATTERN (insn), insn, 0);
3109 if (new_icode < 0)
3110 INSN_CODE (insn) = icode;
3114 /* Restore the old body. If there were any changes to it, we made a copy
3115 of it while the changes were still in place, so we'll correctly return
3116 a modified insn below. */
3117 if (! replace)
3119 /* Restore the old body. */
3120 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3121 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = orig_operand[i];
3122 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3123 *recog_data.dup_loc[i] = orig_operand[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3126 /* Update all elimination pairs to reflect the status after the current
3127 insn. The changes we make were determined by the earlier call to
3128 elimination_effects.
3130 We also detect a cases where register elimination cannot be done,
3131 namely, if a register would be both changed and referenced outside a MEM
3132 in the resulting insn since such an insn is often undefined and, even if
3133 not, we cannot know what meaning will be given to it. Note that it is
3134 valid to have a register used in an address in an insn that changes it
3135 (presumably with a pre- or post-increment or decrement).
3137 If anything changes, return nonzero. */
3139 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3141 if (ep->previous_offset != ep->offset && ep->ref_outside_mem)
3142 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3144 ep->ref_outside_mem = 0;
3146 if (ep->previous_offset != ep->offset)
3147 val = 1;
3150 done:
3151 /* If we changed something, perform elimination in REG_NOTES. This is
3152 needed even when REPLACE is zero because a REG_DEAD note might refer
3153 to a register that we eliminate and could cause a different number
3154 of spill registers to be needed in the final reload pass than in
3155 the pre-passes. */
3156 if (val && REG_NOTES (insn) != 0)
3157 REG_NOTES (insn) = eliminate_regs (REG_NOTES (insn), 0, REG_NOTES (insn));
3159 return val;
3162 /* Loop through all elimination pairs.
3163 Recalculate the number not at initial offset.
3165 Compute the maximum offset (minimum offset if the stack does not
3166 grow downward) for each elimination pair. */
3168 static void
3169 update_eliminable_offsets ()
3171 struct elim_table *ep;
3173 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3174 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3176 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset;
3177 if (ep->can_eliminate && ep->offset != ep->initial_offset)
3178 num_not_at_initial_offset++;
3182 /* Given X, a SET or CLOBBER of DEST, if DEST is the target of a register
3183 replacement we currently believe is valid, mark it as not eliminable if X
3184 modifies DEST in any way other than by adding a constant integer to it.
3186 If DEST is the frame pointer, we do nothing because we assume that
3187 all assignments to the hard frame pointer are nonlocal gotos and are being
3188 done at a time when they are valid and do not disturb anything else.
3189 Some machines want to eliminate a fake argument pointer with either the
3190 frame or stack pointer. Assignments to the hard frame pointer must not
3191 prevent this elimination.
3193 Called via note_stores from reload before starting its passes to scan
3194 the insns of the function. */
3196 static void
3197 mark_not_eliminable (dest, x, data)
3198 rtx dest;
3199 rtx x;
3200 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
3202 register unsigned int i;
3204 /* A SUBREG of a hard register here is just changing its mode. We should
3205 not see a SUBREG of an eliminable hard register, but check just in
3206 case. */
3207 if (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG)
3208 dest = SUBREG_REG (dest);
3210 if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
3211 return;
3213 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
3214 if (reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate && dest == reg_eliminate[i].to_rtx
3215 && (GET_CODE (x) != SET
3216 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) != PLUS
3217 || XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0) != dest
3218 || GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1)) != CONST_INT))
3220 reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate_previous
3221 = reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate = 0;
3222 num_eliminable--;
3226 /* Verify that the initial elimination offsets did not change since the
3227 last call to set_initial_elim_offsets. This is used to catch cases
3228 where something illegal happened during reload_as_needed that could
3229 cause incorrect code to be generated if we did not check for it. */
3231 static void
3232 verify_initial_elim_offsets ()
3234 int t;
3236 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3237 struct elim_table *ep;
3239 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3241 INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (ep->from, ep->to, t);
3242 if (t != ep->initial_offset)
3243 abort ();
3245 #else
3246 INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (t);
3247 if (t != reg_eliminate[0].initial_offset)
3248 abort ();
3249 #endif
3252 /* Reset all offsets on eliminable registers to their initial values. */
3254 static void
3255 set_initial_elim_offsets ()
3257 struct elim_table *ep = reg_eliminate;
3259 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3260 for (; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3262 INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (ep->from, ep->to, ep->initial_offset);
3263 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset = ep->initial_offset;
3265 #else
3266 INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (ep->initial_offset);
3267 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset = ep->initial_offset;
3268 #endif
3270 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3273 /* Initialize the known label offsets.
3274 Set a known offset for each forced label to be at the initial offset
3275 of each elimination. We do this because we assume that all
3276 computed jumps occur from a location where each elimination is
3277 at its initial offset.
3278 For all other labels, show that we don't know the offsets. */
3280 static void
3281 set_initial_label_offsets ()
3283 rtx x;
3284 memset ((char *) &offsets_known_at[get_first_label_num ()], 0, num_labels);
3286 for (x = forced_labels; x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
3287 if (XEXP (x, 0))
3288 set_label_offsets (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, 1);
3291 /* Set all elimination offsets to the known values for the code label given
3292 by INSN. */
3294 static void
3295 set_offsets_for_label (insn)
3296 rtx insn;
3298 unsigned int i;
3299 int label_nr = CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn);
3300 struct elim_table *ep;
3302 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3303 for (i = 0, ep = reg_eliminate; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; ep++, i++)
3305 ep->offset = ep->previous_offset = offsets_at[label_nr][i];
3306 if (ep->can_eliminate && ep->offset != ep->initial_offset)
3307 num_not_at_initial_offset++;
3311 /* See if anything that happened changes which eliminations are valid.
3312 For example, on the Sparc, whether or not the frame pointer can
3313 be eliminated can depend on what registers have been used. We need
3314 not check some conditions again (such as flag_omit_frame_pointer)
3315 since they can't have changed. */
3317 static void
3318 update_eliminables (pset)
3319 HARD_REG_SET *pset;
3321 #if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3322 int previous_frame_pointer_needed = frame_pointer_needed;
3323 #endif
3324 struct elim_table *ep;
3326 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3327 if ((ep->from == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED)
3328 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3329 || ! CAN_ELIMINATE (ep->from, ep->to)
3330 #endif
3332 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3334 /* Look for the case where we have discovered that we can't replace
3335 register A with register B and that means that we will now be
3336 trying to replace register A with register C. This means we can
3337 no longer replace register C with register B and we need to disable
3338 such an elimination, if it exists. This occurs often with A == ap,
3339 B == sp, and C == fp. */
3341 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3343 struct elim_table *op;
3344 register int new_to = -1;
3346 if (! ep->can_eliminate && ep->can_eliminate_previous)
3348 /* Find the current elimination for ep->from, if there is a
3349 new one. */
3350 for (op = reg_eliminate;
3351 op < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; op++)
3352 if (op->from == ep->from && op->can_eliminate)
3354 new_to = op->to;
3355 break;
3358 /* See if there is an elimination of NEW_TO -> EP->TO. If so,
3359 disable it. */
3360 for (op = reg_eliminate;
3361 op < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; op++)
3362 if (op->from == new_to && op->to == ep->to)
3363 op->can_eliminate = 0;
3367 /* See if any registers that we thought we could eliminate the previous
3368 time are no longer eliminable. If so, something has changed and we
3369 must spill the register. Also, recompute the number of eliminable
3370 registers and see if the frame pointer is needed; it is if there is
3371 no elimination of the frame pointer that we can perform. */
3373 frame_pointer_needed = 1;
3374 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3376 if (ep->can_eliminate && ep->from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3377 && ep->to != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
3378 frame_pointer_needed = 0;
3380 if (! ep->can_eliminate && ep->can_eliminate_previous)
3382 ep->can_eliminate_previous = 0;
3383 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*pset, ep->from);
3384 num_eliminable--;
3388 #if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3389 /* If we didn't need a frame pointer last time, but we do now, spill
3390 the hard frame pointer. */
3391 if (frame_pointer_needed && ! previous_frame_pointer_needed)
3392 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*pset, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
3393 #endif
3396 /* Initialize the table of registers to eliminate. */
3398 static void
3399 init_elim_table ()
3401 struct elim_table *ep;
3402 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3403 struct elim_table_1 *ep1;
3404 #endif
3406 if (!reg_eliminate)
3407 reg_eliminate = (struct elim_table *)
3408 xcalloc (sizeof (struct elim_table), NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS);
3410 /* Does this function require a frame pointer? */
3412 frame_pointer_needed = (! flag_omit_frame_pointer
3413 #ifdef EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
3414 /* ?? If EXIT_IGNORE_STACK is set, we will not save
3415 and restore sp for alloca. So we can't eliminate
3416 the frame pointer in that case. At some point,
3417 we should improve this by emitting the
3418 sp-adjusting insns for this case. */
3419 || (current_function_calls_alloca
3420 && EXIT_IGNORE_STACK)
3421 #endif
3422 || FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED);
3424 num_eliminable = 0;
3426 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3427 for (ep = reg_eliminate, ep1 = reg_eliminate_1;
3428 ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++, ep1++)
3430 ep->from = ep1->from;
3431 ep->to = ep1->to;
3432 ep->can_eliminate = ep->can_eliminate_previous
3433 = (CAN_ELIMINATE (ep->from, ep->to)
3434 && ! (ep->to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM && frame_pointer_needed));
3436 #else
3437 reg_eliminate[0].from = reg_eliminate_1[0].from;
3438 reg_eliminate[0].to = reg_eliminate_1[0].to;
3439 reg_eliminate[0].can_eliminate = reg_eliminate[0].can_eliminate_previous
3440 = ! frame_pointer_needed;
3441 #endif
3443 /* Count the number of eliminable registers and build the FROM and TO
3444 REG rtx's. Note that code in gen_rtx will cause, e.g.,
3445 gen_rtx (REG, Pmode, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM) to equal stack_pointer_rtx.
3446 We depend on this. */
3447 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3449 num_eliminable += ep->can_eliminate;
3450 ep->from_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, ep->from);
3451 ep->to_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, ep->to);
3455 /* Kick all pseudos out of hard register REGNO.
3457 If CANT_ELIMINATE is nonzero, it means that we are doing this spill
3458 because we found we can't eliminate some register. In the case, no pseudos
3459 are allowed to be in the register, even if they are only in a block that
3460 doesn't require spill registers, unlike the case when we are spilling this
3461 hard reg to produce another spill register.
3463 Return nonzero if any pseudos needed to be kicked out. */
3465 static void
3466 spill_hard_reg (regno, cant_eliminate)
3467 unsigned int regno;
3468 int cant_eliminate;
3470 register int i;
3472 if (cant_eliminate)
3474 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs_global, regno);
3475 regs_ever_live[regno] = 1;
3478 /* Spill every pseudo reg that was allocated to this reg
3479 or to something that overlaps this reg. */
3481 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
3482 if (reg_renumber[i] >= 0
3483 && (unsigned int) reg_renumber[i] <= regno
3484 && ((unsigned int) reg_renumber[i]
3485 + HARD_REGNO_NREGS ((unsigned int) reg_renumber[i],
3486 PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (i))
3487 > regno))
3488 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, i);
3491 /* I'm getting weird preprocessor errors if I use IOR_HARD_REG_SET
3492 from within EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET. Hence this awkwardness. */
3494 static void
3495 ior_hard_reg_set (set1, set2)
3496 HARD_REG_SET *set1, *set2;
3498 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (*set1, *set2);
3501 /* After find_reload_regs has been run for all insn that need reloads,
3502 and/or spill_hard_regs was called, this function is used to actually
3503 spill pseudo registers and try to reallocate them. It also sets up the
3504 spill_regs array for use by choose_reload_regs. */
3506 static int
3507 finish_spills (global)
3508 int global;
3510 struct insn_chain *chain;
3511 int something_changed = 0;
3512 int i;
3514 /* Build the spill_regs array for the function. */
3515 /* If there are some registers still to eliminate and one of the spill regs
3516 wasn't ever used before, additional stack space may have to be
3517 allocated to store this register. Thus, we may have changed the offset
3518 between the stack and frame pointers, so mark that something has changed.
3520 One might think that we need only set VAL to 1 if this is a call-used
3521 register. However, the set of registers that must be saved by the
3522 prologue is not identical to the call-used set. For example, the
3523 register used by the call insn for the return PC is a call-used register,
3524 but must be saved by the prologue. */
3526 n_spills = 0;
3527 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
3528 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs, i))
3530 spill_reg_order[i] = n_spills;
3531 spill_regs[n_spills++] = i;
3532 if (num_eliminable && ! regs_ever_live[i])
3533 something_changed = 1;
3534 regs_ever_live[i] = 1;
3536 else
3537 spill_reg_order[i] = -1;
3539 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
3540 (&spilled_pseudos, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i,
3542 /* Record the current hard register the pseudo is allocated to in
3543 pseudo_previous_regs so we avoid reallocating it to the same
3544 hard reg in a later pass. */
3545 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0)
3546 abort ();
3548 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (pseudo_previous_regs[i], reg_renumber[i]);
3549 /* Mark it as no longer having a hard register home. */
3550 reg_renumber[i] = -1;
3551 /* We will need to scan everything again. */
3552 something_changed = 1;
3555 /* Retry global register allocation if possible. */
3556 if (global)
3558 memset ((char *) pseudo_forbidden_regs, 0, max_regno * sizeof (HARD_REG_SET));
3559 /* For every insn that needs reloads, set the registers used as spill
3560 regs in pseudo_forbidden_regs for every pseudo live across the
3561 insn. */
3562 for (chain = insns_need_reload; chain; chain = chain->next_need_reload)
3564 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
3565 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i,
3567 ior_hard_reg_set (pseudo_forbidden_regs + i,
3568 &chain->used_spill_regs);
3570 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
3571 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i,
3573 ior_hard_reg_set (pseudo_forbidden_regs + i,
3574 &chain->used_spill_regs);
3578 /* Retry allocating the spilled pseudos. For each reg, merge the
3579 various reg sets that indicate which hard regs can't be used,
3580 and call retry_global_alloc.
3581 We change spill_pseudos here to only contain pseudos that did not
3582 get a new hard register. */
3583 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
3584 if (reg_old_renumber[i] != reg_renumber[i])
3586 HARD_REG_SET forbidden;
3587 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (forbidden, bad_spill_regs_global);
3588 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (forbidden, pseudo_forbidden_regs[i]);
3589 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (forbidden, pseudo_previous_regs[i]);
3590 retry_global_alloc (i, forbidden);
3591 if (reg_renumber[i] >= 0)
3592 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, i);
3596 /* Fix up the register information in the insn chain.
3597 This involves deleting those of the spilled pseudos which did not get
3598 a new hard register home from the live_{before,after} sets. */
3599 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain; chain = chain->next)
3601 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos;
3602 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos2;
3604 AND_COMPL_REG_SET (&chain->live_throughout, &spilled_pseudos);
3605 AND_COMPL_REG_SET (&chain->dead_or_set, &spilled_pseudos);
3607 /* Mark any unallocated hard regs as available for spills. That
3608 makes inheritance work somewhat better. */
3609 if (chain->need_reload)
3611 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
3612 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2, &chain->dead_or_set);
3613 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, used_by_pseudos2);
3615 /* Save the old value for the sanity test below. */
3616 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2, chain->used_spill_regs);
3618 compute_use_by_pseudos (&used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
3619 compute_use_by_pseudos (&used_by_pseudos, &chain->dead_or_set);
3620 COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos);
3621 AND_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs);
3623 /* Make sure we only enlarge the set. */
3624 GO_IF_HARD_REG_SUBSET (used_by_pseudos2, chain->used_spill_regs, ok);
3625 abort ();
3626 ok:;
3630 /* Let alter_reg modify the reg rtx's for the modified pseudos. */
3631 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
3633 int regno = reg_renumber[i];
3634 if (reg_old_renumber[i] == regno)
3635 continue;
3637 alter_reg (i, reg_old_renumber[i]);
3638 reg_old_renumber[i] = regno;
3639 if (rtl_dump_file)
3641 if (regno == -1)
3642 fprintf (rtl_dump_file, " Register %d now on stack.\n\n", i);
3643 else
3644 fprintf (rtl_dump_file, " Register %d now in %d.\n\n",
3645 i, reg_renumber[i]);
3649 return something_changed;
3652 /* Find all paradoxical subregs within X and update reg_max_ref_width.
3653 Also mark any hard registers used to store user variables as
3654 forbidden from being used for spill registers. */
3656 static void
3657 scan_paradoxical_subregs (x)
3658 register rtx x;
3660 register int i;
3661 register const char *fmt;
3662 register enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
3664 switch (code)
3666 case REG:
3667 #if 0
3668 if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
3669 && REG_USERVAR_P (x))
3670 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs_global, REGNO (x));
3671 #endif
3672 return;
3674 case CONST_INT:
3675 case CONST:
3676 case SYMBOL_REF:
3677 case LABEL_REF:
3678 case CONST_DOUBLE:
3679 case CC0:
3680 case PC:
3681 case USE:
3682 case CLOBBER:
3683 return;
3685 case SUBREG:
3686 if (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x)) == REG
3687 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)) > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
3688 reg_max_ref_width[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))]
3689 = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x));
3690 return;
3692 default:
3693 break;
3696 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
3697 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
3699 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
3700 scan_paradoxical_subregs (XEXP (x, i));
3701 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
3703 register int j;
3704 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
3705 scan_paradoxical_subregs (XVECEXP (x, i, j));
3710 /* Reload pseudo-registers into hard regs around each insn as needed.
3711 Additional register load insns are output before the insn that needs it
3712 and perhaps store insns after insns that modify the reloaded pseudo reg.
3714 reg_last_reload_reg and reg_reloaded_contents keep track of
3715 which registers are already available in reload registers.
3716 We update these for the reloads that we perform,
3717 as the insns are scanned. */
3719 static void
3720 reload_as_needed (live_known)
3721 int live_known;
3723 struct insn_chain *chain;
3724 #if defined (AUTO_INC_DEC)
3725 register int i;
3726 #endif
3727 rtx x;
3729 memset ((char *) spill_reg_rtx, 0, sizeof spill_reg_rtx);
3730 memset ((char *) spill_reg_store, 0, sizeof spill_reg_store);
3731 reg_last_reload_reg = (rtx *) xcalloc (max_regno, sizeof (rtx));
3732 reg_has_output_reload = (char *) xmalloc (max_regno);
3733 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid);
3735 set_initial_elim_offsets ();
3737 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain; chain = chain->next)
3739 rtx prev;
3740 rtx insn = chain->insn;
3741 rtx old_next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
3743 /* If we pass a label, copy the offsets from the label information
3744 into the current offsets of each elimination. */
3745 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL)
3746 set_offsets_for_label (insn);
3748 else if (INSN_P (insn))
3750 rtx oldpat = PATTERN (insn);
3752 /* If this is a USE and CLOBBER of a MEM, ensure that any
3753 references to eliminable registers have been removed. */
3755 if ((GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
3756 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER)
3757 && GET_CODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)) == MEM)
3758 XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0)
3759 = eliminate_regs (XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0),
3760 GET_MODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)),
3761 NULL_RTX);
3763 /* If we need to do register elimination processing, do so.
3764 This might delete the insn, in which case we are done. */
3765 if ((num_eliminable || num_eliminable_invariants) && chain->need_elim)
3767 eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn, 1);
3768 if (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE)
3770 update_eliminable_offsets ();
3771 continue;
3775 /* If need_elim is nonzero but need_reload is zero, one might think
3776 that we could simply set n_reloads to 0. However, find_reloads
3777 could have done some manipulation of the insn (such as swapping
3778 commutative operands), and these manipulations are lost during
3779 the first pass for every insn that needs register elimination.
3780 So the actions of find_reloads must be redone here. */
3782 if (! chain->need_elim && ! chain->need_reload
3783 && ! chain->need_operand_change)
3784 n_reloads = 0;
3785 /* First find the pseudo regs that must be reloaded for this insn.
3786 This info is returned in the tables reload_... (see reload.h).
3787 Also modify the body of INSN by substituting RELOAD
3788 rtx's for those pseudo regs. */
3789 else
3791 memset (reg_has_output_reload, 0, max_regno);
3792 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_is_output_reload);
3794 find_reloads (insn, 1, spill_indirect_levels, live_known,
3795 spill_reg_order);
3798 if (num_eliminable && chain->need_elim)
3799 update_eliminable_offsets ();
3801 if (n_reloads > 0)
3803 rtx next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
3804 rtx p;
3806 prev = PREV_INSN (insn);
3808 /* Now compute which reload regs to reload them into. Perhaps
3809 reusing reload regs from previous insns, or else output
3810 load insns to reload them. Maybe output store insns too.
3811 Record the choices of reload reg in reload_reg_rtx. */
3812 choose_reload_regs (chain);
3814 /* Merge any reloads that we didn't combine for fear of
3815 increasing the number of spill registers needed but now
3816 discover can be safely merged. */
3817 if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES)
3818 merge_assigned_reloads (insn);
3820 /* Generate the insns to reload operands into or out of
3821 their reload regs. */
3822 emit_reload_insns (chain);
3824 /* Substitute the chosen reload regs from reload_reg_rtx
3825 into the insn's body (or perhaps into the bodies of other
3826 load and store insn that we just made for reloading
3827 and that we moved the structure into). */
3828 subst_reloads ();
3830 /* If this was an ASM, make sure that all the reload insns
3831 we have generated are valid. If not, give an error
3832 and delete them. */
3834 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
3835 for (p = NEXT_INSN (prev); p != next; p = NEXT_INSN (p))
3836 if (p != insn && INSN_P (p)
3837 && (recog_memoized (p) < 0
3838 || (extract_insn (p), ! constrain_operands (1))))
3840 error_for_asm (insn,
3841 "`asm' operand requires impossible reload");
3842 PUT_CODE (p, NOTE);
3843 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (p) = 0;
3844 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (p) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
3847 /* Any previously reloaded spilled pseudo reg, stored in this insn,
3848 is no longer validly lying around to save a future reload.
3849 Note that this does not detect pseudos that were reloaded
3850 for this insn in order to be stored in
3851 (obeying register constraints). That is correct; such reload
3852 registers ARE still valid. */
3853 note_stores (oldpat, forget_old_reloads_1, NULL);
3855 /* There may have been CLOBBER insns placed after INSN. So scan
3856 between INSN and NEXT and use them to forget old reloads. */
3857 for (x = NEXT_INSN (insn); x != old_next; x = NEXT_INSN (x))
3858 if (GET_CODE (x) == INSN && GET_CODE (PATTERN (x)) == CLOBBER)
3859 note_stores (PATTERN (x), forget_old_reloads_1, NULL);
3861 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
3862 /* Likewise for regs altered by auto-increment in this insn.
3863 REG_INC notes have been changed by reloading:
3864 find_reloads_address_1 records substitutions for them,
3865 which have been performed by subst_reloads above. */
3866 for (i = n_reloads - 1; i >= 0; i--)
3868 rtx in_reg = rld[i].in_reg;
3869 if (in_reg)
3871 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (in_reg);
3872 /* PRE_INC / PRE_DEC will have the reload register ending up
3873 with the same value as the stack slot, but that doesn't
3874 hold true for POST_INC / POST_DEC. Either we have to
3875 convert the memory access to a true POST_INC / POST_DEC,
3876 or we can't use the reload register for inheritance. */
3877 if ((code == POST_INC || code == POST_DEC)
3878 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid,
3879 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx))
3880 /* Make sure it is the inc/dec pseudo, and not
3881 some other (e.g. output operand) pseudo. */
3882 && (reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx)]
3883 == REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0))))
3886 rtx reload_reg = rld[i].reg_rtx;
3887 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (reload_reg);
3888 int n = 0;
3889 rtx p;
3891 for (p = PREV_INSN (old_next); p != prev; p = PREV_INSN (p))
3893 /* We really want to ignore REG_INC notes here, so
3894 use PATTERN (p) as argument to reg_set_p . */
3895 if (reg_set_p (reload_reg, PATTERN (p)))
3896 break;
3897 n = count_occurrences (PATTERN (p), reload_reg, 0);
3898 if (! n)
3899 continue;
3900 if (n == 1)
3902 n = validate_replace_rtx (reload_reg,
3903 gen_rtx (code, mode,
3904 reload_reg),
3907 /* We must also verify that the constraints
3908 are met after the replacement. */
3909 extract_insn (p);
3910 if (n)
3911 n = constrain_operands (1);
3912 else
3913 break;
3915 /* If the constraints were not met, then
3916 undo the replacement. */
3917 if (!n)
3919 validate_replace_rtx (gen_rtx (code, mode,
3920 reload_reg),
3921 reload_reg, p);
3922 break;
3926 break;
3928 if (n == 1)
3930 REG_NOTES (p)
3931 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_INC, reload_reg,
3932 REG_NOTES (p));
3933 /* Mark this as having an output reload so that the
3934 REG_INC processing code below won't invalidate
3935 the reload for inheritance. */
3936 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
3937 REGNO (reload_reg));
3938 reg_has_output_reload[REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0))] = 1;
3940 else
3941 forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (in_reg, 0), NULL_RTX,
3942 NULL);
3944 else if ((code == PRE_INC || code == PRE_DEC)
3945 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid,
3946 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx))
3947 /* Make sure it is the inc/dec pseudo, and not
3948 some other (e.g. output operand) pseudo. */
3949 && (reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx)]
3950 == REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0))))
3952 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
3953 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx));
3954 reg_has_output_reload[REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0))] = 1;
3958 /* If a pseudo that got a hard register is auto-incremented,
3959 we must purge records of copying it into pseudos without
3960 hard registers. */
3961 for (x = REG_NOTES (insn); x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
3962 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (x) == REG_INC)
3964 /* See if this pseudo reg was reloaded in this insn.
3965 If so, its last-reload info is still valid
3966 because it is based on this insn's reload. */
3967 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
3968 if (rld[i].out == XEXP (x, 0))
3969 break;
3971 if (i == n_reloads)
3972 forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, NULL);
3974 #endif
3976 /* A reload reg's contents are unknown after a label. */
3977 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL)
3978 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid);
3980 /* Don't assume a reload reg is still good after a call insn
3981 if it is a call-used reg. */
3982 else if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
3983 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET(reg_reloaded_valid, call_used_reg_set);
3986 /* Clean up. */
3987 free (reg_last_reload_reg);
3988 free (reg_has_output_reload);
3991 /* Discard all record of any value reloaded from X,
3992 or reloaded in X from someplace else;
3993 unless X is an output reload reg of the current insn.
3995 X may be a hard reg (the reload reg)
3996 or it may be a pseudo reg that was reloaded from. */
3998 static void
3999 forget_old_reloads_1 (x, ignored, data)
4000 rtx x;
4001 rtx ignored ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4002 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4004 unsigned int regno;
4005 unsigned int nr;
4006 int offset = 0;
4008 /* note_stores does give us subregs of hard regs. */
4009 while (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
4011 offset += SUBREG_WORD (x);
4012 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
4015 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG)
4016 return;
4018 regno = REGNO (x) + offset;
4020 if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4021 nr = 1;
4022 else
4024 unsigned int i;
4026 nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (x));
4027 /* Storing into a spilled-reg invalidates its contents.
4028 This can happen if a block-local pseudo is allocated to that reg
4029 and it wasn't spilled because this block's total need is 0.
4030 Then some insn might have an optional reload and use this reg. */
4031 for (i = 0; i < nr; i++)
4032 /* But don't do this if the reg actually serves as an output
4033 reload reg in the current instruction. */
4034 if (n_reloads == 0
4035 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, regno + i))
4037 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno + i);
4038 spill_reg_store[regno + i] = 0;
4042 /* Since value of X has changed,
4043 forget any value previously copied from it. */
4045 while (nr-- > 0)
4046 /* But don't forget a copy if this is the output reload
4047 that establishes the copy's validity. */
4048 if (n_reloads == 0 || reg_has_output_reload[regno + nr] == 0)
4049 reg_last_reload_reg[regno + nr] = 0;
4052 /* The following HARD_REG_SETs indicate when each hard register is
4053 used for a reload of various parts of the current insn. */
4055 /* If reg is unavailable for all reloads. */
4056 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_unavailable;
4057 /* If reg is in use as a reload reg for a RELOAD_OTHER reload. */
4058 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used;
4059 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4060 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4061 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4062 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4063 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4064 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4065 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4066 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4067 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reload for operand I. */
4068 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_input[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4069 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reload for operand I. */
4070 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_output[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4071 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reload. */
4072 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_op_addr;
4073 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR reload. */
4074 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload;
4075 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INSN reload. */
4076 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_insn;
4077 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reload. */
4078 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_other_addr;
4080 /* If reg is in use as a reload reg for any sort of reload. */
4081 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_at_all;
4083 /* If reg is use as an inherited reload. We just mark the first register
4084 in the group. */
4085 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_for_inherit;
4087 /* Records which hard regs are used in any way, either as explicit use or
4088 by being allocated to a pseudo during any point of the current insn. */
4089 static HARD_REG_SET reg_used_in_insn;
4091 /* Mark reg REGNO as in use for a reload of the sort spec'd by OPNUM and
4092 TYPE. MODE is used to indicate how many consecutive regs are
4093 actually used. */
4095 static void
4096 mark_reload_reg_in_use (regno, opnum, type, mode)
4097 unsigned int regno;
4098 int opnum;
4099 enum reload_type type;
4100 enum machine_mode mode;
4102 unsigned int nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode);
4103 unsigned int i;
4105 for (i = regno; i < nregs + regno; i++)
4107 switch (type)
4109 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4110 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, i);
4111 break;
4113 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4114 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum], i);
4115 break;
4117 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4118 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], i);
4119 break;
4121 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4122 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum], i);
4123 break;
4125 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4126 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum], i);
4127 break;
4129 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4130 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, i);
4131 break;
4133 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4134 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, i);
4135 break;
4137 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4138 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, i);
4139 break;
4141 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4142 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[opnum], i);
4143 break;
4145 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4146 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[opnum], i);
4147 break;
4149 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4150 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, i);
4151 break;
4154 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all, i);
4158 /* Similarly, but show REGNO is no longer in use for a reload. */
4160 static void
4161 clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno, opnum, type, mode)
4162 unsigned int regno;
4163 int opnum;
4164 enum reload_type type;
4165 enum machine_mode mode;
4167 unsigned int nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode);
4168 unsigned int start_regno, end_regno, r;
4169 int i;
4170 /* A complication is that for some reload types, inheritance might
4171 allow multiple reloads of the same types to share a reload register.
4172 We set check_opnum if we have to check only reloads with the same
4173 operand number, and check_any if we have to check all reloads. */
4174 int check_opnum = 0;
4175 int check_any = 0;
4176 HARD_REG_SET *used_in_set;
4178 switch (type)
4180 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4181 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used;
4182 break;
4184 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4185 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum];
4186 break;
4188 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4189 check_opnum = 1;
4190 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum];
4191 break;
4193 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4194 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum];
4195 break;
4197 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4198 check_opnum = 1;
4199 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum];
4200 break;
4202 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4203 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_op_addr;
4204 break;
4206 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4207 check_any = 1;
4208 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload;
4209 break;
4211 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4212 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_other_addr;
4213 check_any = 1;
4214 break;
4216 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4217 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_input[opnum];
4218 break;
4220 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4221 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_output[opnum];
4222 break;
4224 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4225 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_insn;
4226 break;
4227 default:
4228 abort ();
4230 /* We resolve conflicts with remaining reloads of the same type by
4231 excluding the intervals of of reload registers by them from the
4232 interval of freed reload registers. Since we only keep track of
4233 one set of interval bounds, we might have to exclude somewhat
4234 more then what would be necessary if we used a HARD_REG_SET here.
4235 But this should only happen very infrequently, so there should
4236 be no reason to worry about it. */
4238 start_regno = regno;
4239 end_regno = regno + nregs;
4240 if (check_opnum || check_any)
4242 for (i = n_reloads - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4244 if (rld[i].when_needed == type
4245 && (check_any || rld[i].opnum == opnum)
4246 && rld[i].reg_rtx)
4248 unsigned int conflict_start = true_regnum (rld[i].reg_rtx);
4249 unsigned int conflict_end
4250 = (conflict_start
4251 + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (conflict_start, rld[i].mode));
4253 /* If there is an overlap with the first to-be-freed register,
4254 adjust the interval start. */
4255 if (conflict_start <= start_regno && conflict_end > start_regno)
4256 start_regno = conflict_end;
4257 /* Otherwise, if there is a conflict with one of the other
4258 to-be-freed registers, adjust the interval end. */
4259 if (conflict_start > start_regno && conflict_start < end_regno)
4260 end_regno = conflict_start;
4265 for (r = start_regno; r < end_regno; r++)
4266 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (*used_in_set, r);
4269 /* 1 if reg REGNO is free as a reload reg for a reload of the sort
4270 specified by OPNUM and TYPE. */
4272 static int
4273 reload_reg_free_p (regno, opnum, type)
4274 unsigned int regno;
4275 int opnum;
4276 enum reload_type type;
4278 int i;
4280 /* In use for a RELOAD_OTHER means it's not available for anything. */
4281 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno)
4282 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable, regno))
4283 return 0;
4285 switch (type)
4287 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4288 /* In use for anything means we can't use it for RELOAD_OTHER. */
4289 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno)
4290 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
4291 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno))
4292 return 0;
4294 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4295 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4296 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
4297 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4298 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4299 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno)
4300 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4301 return 0;
4303 return 1;
4305 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4306 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4307 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno))
4308 return 0;
4310 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno))
4311 return 0;
4313 /* If it is used for some other input, can't use it. */
4314 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4315 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4316 return 0;
4318 /* If it is used in a later operand's address, can't use it. */
4319 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4320 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4321 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno))
4322 return 0;
4324 return 1;
4326 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4327 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an input address for this
4328 operand or used as an input in an earlier one. */
4329 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum], regno)
4330 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
4331 return 0;
4333 for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
4334 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4335 return 0;
4337 return 1;
4339 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4340 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an input address
4341 for this operand or used as an input in an earlier
4342 one. */
4343 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
4344 return 0;
4346 for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
4347 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4348 return 0;
4350 return 1;
4352 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4353 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an output address for this
4354 operand or used as an output in this or a later operand. */
4355 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum], regno))
4356 return 0;
4358 for (i = opnum; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4359 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4360 return 0;
4362 return 1;
4364 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4365 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an output address
4366 for this operand or used as an output in this or a
4367 later operand. */
4368 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
4369 return 0;
4371 for (i = opnum; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4372 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4373 return 0;
4375 return 1;
4377 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4378 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4379 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4380 return 0;
4382 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4383 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno));
4385 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4386 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4387 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4388 return 0;
4390 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno));
4392 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4393 /* This cannot share a register with RELOAD_FOR_INSN reloads, other
4394 outputs, or an operand address for this or an earlier output. */
4395 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno))
4396 return 0;
4398 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4399 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4400 return 0;
4402 for (i = 0; i <= opnum; i++)
4403 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4404 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno))
4405 return 0;
4407 return 1;
4409 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4410 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4411 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno)
4412 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4413 return 0;
4415 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4416 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno));
4418 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4419 return ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno);
4421 abort ();
4424 /* Return 1 if the value in reload reg REGNO, as used by a reload
4425 needed for the part of the insn specified by OPNUM and TYPE,
4426 is still available in REGNO at the end of the insn.
4428 We can assume that the reload reg was already tested for availability
4429 at the time it is needed, and we should not check this again,
4430 in case the reg has already been marked in use. */
4432 static int
4433 reload_reg_reaches_end_p (regno, opnum, type)
4434 unsigned int regno;
4435 int opnum;
4436 enum reload_type type;
4438 int i;
4440 switch (type)
4442 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4443 /* Since a RELOAD_OTHER reload claims the reg for the entire insn,
4444 its value must reach the end. */
4445 return 1;
4447 /* If this use is for part of the insn,
4448 its value reaches if no subsequent part uses the same register.
4449 Just like the above function, don't try to do this with lots
4450 of fallthroughs. */
4452 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4453 /* Here we check for everything else, since these don't conflict
4454 with anything else and everything comes later. */
4456 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4457 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4458 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4459 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno)
4460 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4461 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
4462 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4463 return 0;
4465 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
4466 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4467 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
4469 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4470 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4471 /* Similar, except that we check only for this and subsequent inputs
4472 and the address of only subsequent inputs and we do not need
4473 to check for RELOAD_OTHER objects since they are known not to
4474 conflict. */
4476 for (i = opnum; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4477 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4478 return 0;
4480 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4481 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4482 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno))
4483 return 0;
4485 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4486 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4487 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4488 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4489 return 0;
4491 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno))
4492 return 0;
4494 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
4495 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4496 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
4498 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4499 /* Similar to input address, except we start at the next operand for
4500 both input and input address and we do not check for
4501 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_INSN since these
4502 would conflict. */
4504 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4505 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4506 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
4507 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4508 return 0;
4510 /* ... fall through ... */
4512 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4513 /* Check outputs and their addresses. */
4515 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4516 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4517 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4518 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4519 return 0;
4521 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
4523 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4524 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4525 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4526 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4527 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4528 return 0;
4530 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
4531 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4532 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
4534 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4535 /* These conflict with other outputs with RELOAD_OTHER. So
4536 we need only check for output addresses. */
4538 opnum = -1;
4540 /* ... fall through ... */
4542 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4543 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4544 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4545 /* We already know these can't conflict with a later output. So the
4546 only thing to check are later output addresses. */
4547 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4548 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4549 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno))
4550 return 0;
4552 return 1;
4555 abort ();
4558 /* Return 1 if the reloads denoted by R1 and R2 cannot share a register.
4559 Return 0 otherwise.
4561 This function uses the same algorithm as reload_reg_free_p above. */
4564 reloads_conflict (r1, r2)
4565 int r1, r2;
4567 enum reload_type r1_type = rld[r1].when_needed;
4568 enum reload_type r2_type = rld[r2].when_needed;
4569 int r1_opnum = rld[r1].opnum;
4570 int r2_opnum = rld[r2].opnum;
4572 /* RELOAD_OTHER conflicts with everything. */
4573 if (r2_type == RELOAD_OTHER)
4574 return 1;
4576 /* Otherwise, check conflicts differently for each type. */
4578 switch (r1_type)
4580 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4581 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
4582 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
4583 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
4584 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
4585 || ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
4586 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS)
4587 && r2_opnum > r1_opnum));
4589 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4590 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS && r1_opnum == r2_opnum)
4591 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && r2_opnum < r1_opnum));
4593 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4594 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS && r1_opnum == r2_opnum)
4595 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && r2_opnum < r1_opnum));
4597 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4598 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS && r2_opnum == r1_opnum)
4599 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT && r2_opnum >= r1_opnum));
4601 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4602 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS && r2_opnum == r1_opnum)
4603 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT && r2_opnum >= r1_opnum));
4605 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4606 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
4607 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS);
4609 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4610 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
4611 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR);
4613 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4614 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
4615 || ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
4616 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS)
4617 && r2_opnum <= r1_opnum));
4619 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4620 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
4621 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
4622 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS);
4624 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4625 return r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS;
4627 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4628 return 1;
4630 default:
4631 abort ();
4635 /* Indexed by reload number, 1 if incoming value
4636 inherited from previous insns. */
4637 char reload_inherited[MAX_RELOADS];
4639 /* For an inherited reload, this is the insn the reload was inherited from,
4640 if we know it. Otherwise, this is 0. */
4641 rtx reload_inheritance_insn[MAX_RELOADS];
4643 /* If non-zero, this is a place to get the value of the reload,
4644 rather than using reload_in. */
4645 rtx reload_override_in[MAX_RELOADS];
4647 /* For each reload, the hard register number of the register used,
4648 or -1 if we did not need a register for this reload. */
4649 int reload_spill_index[MAX_RELOADS];
4651 /* Return 1 if the value in reload reg REGNO, as used by a reload
4652 needed for the part of the insn specified by OPNUM and TYPE,
4653 may be used to load VALUE into it.
4655 Other read-only reloads with the same value do not conflict
4656 unless OUT is non-zero and these other reloads have to live while
4657 output reloads live.
4658 If OUT is CONST0_RTX, this is a special case: it means that the
4659 test should not be for using register REGNO as reload register, but
4660 for copying from register REGNO into the reload register.
4662 RELOADNUM is the number of the reload we want to load this value for;
4663 a reload does not conflict with itself.
4665 When IGNORE_ADDRESS_RELOADS is set, we can not have conflicts with
4666 reloads that load an address for the very reload we are considering.
4668 The caller has to make sure that there is no conflict with the return
4669 register. */
4670 static int
4671 reload_reg_free_for_value_p (regno, opnum, type, value, out, reloadnum,
4672 ignore_address_reloads)
4673 int regno;
4674 int opnum;
4675 enum reload_type type;
4676 rtx value, out;
4677 int reloadnum;
4678 int ignore_address_reloads;
4680 int time1;
4681 /* Set if we see an input reload that must not share its reload register
4682 with any new earlyclobber, but might otherwise share the reload
4683 register with an output or input-output reload. */
4684 int check_earlyclobber = 0;
4685 int i;
4686 int copy = 0;
4688 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable, regno))
4689 return 0;
4691 if (out == const0_rtx)
4693 copy = 1;
4694 out = NULL_RTX;
4697 /* We use some pseudo 'time' value to check if the lifetimes of the
4698 new register use would overlap with the one of a previous reload
4699 that is not read-only or uses a different value.
4700 The 'time' used doesn't have to be linear in any shape or form, just
4701 monotonic.
4702 Some reload types use different 'buckets' for each operand.
4703 So there are MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS different time values for each
4704 such reload type.
4705 We compute TIME1 as the time when the register for the prospective
4706 new reload ceases to be live, and TIME2 for each existing
4707 reload as the time when that the reload register of that reload
4708 becomes live.
4709 Where there is little to be gained by exact lifetime calculations,
4710 we just make conservative assumptions, i.e. a longer lifetime;
4711 this is done in the 'default:' cases. */
4712 switch (type)
4714 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4715 /* RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS conflicts with RELOAD_OTHER reloads. */
4716 time1 = copy ? 0 : 1;
4717 break;
4718 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4719 time1 = copy ? 1 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 5 + 5;
4720 break;
4721 /* For each input, we may have a sequence of RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS,
4722 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_INPUT. By adding 0 / 1 / 2 ,
4723 respectively, to the time values for these, we get distinct time
4724 values. To get distinct time values for each operand, we have to
4725 multiply opnum by at least three. We round that up to four because
4726 multiply by four is often cheaper. */
4727 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4728 time1 = opnum * 4 + 2;
4729 break;
4730 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4731 time1 = opnum * 4 + 3;
4732 break;
4733 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4734 /* All RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reloads remain live till the instruction
4735 executes (inclusive). */
4736 time1 = copy ? opnum * 4 + 4 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
4737 break;
4738 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4739 /* opnum * 4 + 4
4740 <= (MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS - 1) * 4 + 4 == MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 */
4741 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 1;
4742 break;
4743 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4744 /* RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads are live even while the insn
4745 is executed. */
4746 time1 = copy ? MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 2 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
4747 break;
4748 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4749 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4 + opnum;
4750 break;
4751 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4752 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 5 + opnum;
4753 break;
4754 default:
4755 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 5 + 5;
4758 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
4760 rtx reg = rld[i].reg_rtx;
4761 if (reg && GET_CODE (reg) == REG
4762 && ((unsigned) regno - true_regnum (reg)
4763 <= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO (reg), GET_MODE (reg)) - (unsigned)1)
4764 && i != reloadnum)
4766 if (! rld[i].in || ! rtx_equal_p (rld[i].in, value)
4767 || rld[i].out || out)
4769 int time2;
4770 switch (rld[i].when_needed)
4772 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4773 time2 = 0;
4774 break;
4775 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4776 /* find_reloads makes sure that a
4777 RELOAD_FOR_{INP,OP,OUT}ADDR_ADDRESS reload is only used
4778 by at most one - the first -
4779 RELOAD_FOR_{INPUT,OPERAND,OUTPUT}_ADDRESS . If the
4780 address reload is inherited, the address address reload
4781 goes away, so we can ignore this conflict. */
4782 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
4783 && ignore_address_reloads
4784 /* Unless the RELOAD_FOR_INPUT is an auto_inc expression.
4785 Then the address address is still needed to store
4786 back the new address. */
4787 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
4788 continue;
4789 /* Likewise, if a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT can inherit a value, its
4790 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS / RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
4791 reloads go away. */
4792 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && opnum == rld[i].opnum
4793 && ignore_address_reloads
4794 /* Unless we are reloading an auto_inc expression. */
4795 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
4796 continue;
4797 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 2;
4798 break;
4799 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4800 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && opnum == rld[i].opnum
4801 && ignore_address_reloads
4802 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
4803 continue;
4804 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 3;
4805 break;
4806 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4807 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 4;
4808 check_earlyclobber = 1;
4809 break;
4810 /* rld[i].opnum * 4 + 4 <= (MAX_RECOG_OPERAND - 1) * 4 + 4
4811 == MAX_RECOG_OPERAND * 4 */
4812 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4813 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
4814 && ignore_address_reloads
4815 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
4816 continue;
4817 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 1;
4818 break;
4819 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4820 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 2;
4821 check_earlyclobber = 1;
4822 break;
4823 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4824 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
4825 break;
4826 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4827 /* All RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reloads become live just after the
4828 instruction is executed. */
4829 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4;
4830 break;
4831 /* The first RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reload conflicts with
4832 the RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reloads, so assign it the same time
4833 value. */
4834 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4835 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
4836 && ignore_address_reloads
4837 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
4838 continue;
4839 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4 + rld[i].opnum;
4840 break;
4841 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4842 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 5 + rld[i].opnum;
4843 break;
4844 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4845 /* If there is no conflict in the input part, handle this
4846 like an output reload. */
4847 if (! rld[i].in || rtx_equal_p (rld[i].in, value))
4849 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4;
4850 /* Earlyclobbered outputs must conflict with inputs. */
4851 if (earlyclobber_operand_p (rld[i].out))
4852 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
4854 break;
4856 time2 = 1;
4857 /* RELOAD_OTHER might be live beyond instruction execution,
4858 but this is not obvious when we set time2 = 1. So check
4859 here if there might be a problem with the new reload
4860 clobbering the register used by the RELOAD_OTHER. */
4861 if (out)
4862 return 0;
4863 break;
4864 default:
4865 return 0;
4867 if ((time1 >= time2
4868 && (! rld[i].in || rld[i].out
4869 || ! rtx_equal_p (rld[i].in, value)))
4870 || (out && rld[reloadnum].out_reg
4871 && time2 >= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3))
4872 return 0;
4877 /* Earlyclobbered outputs must conflict with inputs. */
4878 if (check_earlyclobber && out && earlyclobber_operand_p (out))
4879 return 0;
4881 return 1;
4884 /* Give an error message saying we failed to find a reload for INSN,
4885 and clear out reload R. */
4886 static void
4887 failed_reload (insn, r)
4888 rtx insn;
4889 int r;
4891 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) < 0)
4892 /* It's the compiler's fault. */
4893 fatal_insn ("Could not find a spill register", insn);
4895 /* It's the user's fault; the operand's mode and constraint
4896 don't match. Disable this reload so we don't crash in final. */
4897 error_for_asm (insn,
4898 "`asm' operand constraint incompatible with operand size");
4899 rld[r].in = 0;
4900 rld[r].out = 0;
4901 rld[r].reg_rtx = 0;
4902 rld[r].optional = 1;
4903 rld[r].secondary_p = 1;
4906 /* I is the index in SPILL_REG_RTX of the reload register we are to allocate
4907 for reload R. If it's valid, get an rtx for it. Return nonzero if
4908 successful. */
4909 static int
4910 set_reload_reg (i, r)
4911 int i, r;
4913 int regno;
4914 rtx reg = spill_reg_rtx[i];
4916 if (reg == 0 || GET_MODE (reg) != rld[r].mode)
4917 spill_reg_rtx[i] = reg
4918 = gen_rtx_REG (rld[r].mode, spill_regs[i]);
4920 regno = true_regnum (reg);
4922 /* Detect when the reload reg can't hold the reload mode.
4923 This used to be one `if', but Sequent compiler can't handle that. */
4924 if (HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rld[r].mode))
4926 enum machine_mode test_mode = VOIDmode;
4927 if (rld[r].in)
4928 test_mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in);
4929 /* If rld[r].in has VOIDmode, it means we will load it
4930 in whatever mode the reload reg has: to wit, rld[r].mode.
4931 We have already tested that for validity. */
4932 /* Aside from that, we need to test that the expressions
4933 to reload from or into have modes which are valid for this
4934 reload register. Otherwise the reload insns would be invalid. */
4935 if (! (rld[r].in != 0 && test_mode != VOIDmode
4936 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, test_mode)))
4937 if (! (rld[r].out != 0
4938 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, GET_MODE (rld[r].out))))
4940 /* The reg is OK. */
4941 last_spill_reg = i;
4943 /* Mark as in use for this insn the reload regs we use
4944 for this. */
4945 mark_reload_reg_in_use (spill_regs[i], rld[r].opnum,
4946 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].mode);
4948 rld[r].reg_rtx = reg;
4949 reload_spill_index[r] = spill_regs[i];
4950 return 1;
4953 return 0;
4956 /* Find a spill register to use as a reload register for reload R.
4957 LAST_RELOAD is non-zero if this is the last reload for the insn being
4958 processed.
4960 Set rld[R].reg_rtx to the register allocated.
4962 We return 1 if successful, or 0 if we couldn't find a spill reg and
4963 we didn't change anything. */
4965 static int
4966 allocate_reload_reg (chain, r, last_reload)
4967 struct insn_chain *chain ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4968 int r;
4969 int last_reload;
4971 int i, pass, count;
4973 /* If we put this reload ahead, thinking it is a group,
4974 then insist on finding a group. Otherwise we can grab a
4975 reg that some other reload needs.
4976 (That can happen when we have a 68000 DATA_OR_FP_REG
4977 which is a group of data regs or one fp reg.)
4978 We need not be so restrictive if there are no more reloads
4979 for this insn.
4981 ??? Really it would be nicer to have smarter handling
4982 for that kind of reg class, where a problem like this is normal.
4983 Perhaps those classes should be avoided for reloading
4984 by use of more alternatives. */
4986 int force_group = rld[r].nregs > 1 && ! last_reload;
4988 /* If we want a single register and haven't yet found one,
4989 take any reg in the right class and not in use.
4990 If we want a consecutive group, here is where we look for it.
4992 We use two passes so we can first look for reload regs to
4993 reuse, which are already in use for other reloads in this insn,
4994 and only then use additional registers.
4995 I think that maximizing reuse is needed to make sure we don't
4996 run out of reload regs. Suppose we have three reloads, and
4997 reloads A and B can share regs. These need two regs.
4998 Suppose A and B are given different regs.
4999 That leaves none for C. */
5000 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; pass++)
5002 /* I is the index in spill_regs.
5003 We advance it round-robin between insns to use all spill regs
5004 equally, so that inherited reloads have a chance
5005 of leapfrogging each other. */
5007 i = last_spill_reg;
5009 for (count = 0; count < n_spills; count++)
5011 int class = (int) rld[r].class;
5012 int regnum;
5014 i++;
5015 if (i >= n_spills)
5016 i -= n_spills;
5017 regnum = spill_regs[i];
5019 if ((reload_reg_free_p (regnum, rld[r].opnum,
5020 rld[r].when_needed)
5021 || (rld[r].in
5022 /* We check reload_reg_used to make sure we
5023 don't clobber the return register. */
5024 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regnum)
5025 && reload_reg_free_for_value_p (regnum,
5026 rld[r].opnum,
5027 rld[r].when_needed,
5028 rld[r].in,
5029 rld[r].out, r, 1)))
5030 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], regnum)
5031 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regnum, rld[r].mode)
5032 /* Look first for regs to share, then for unshared. But
5033 don't share regs used for inherited reloads; they are
5034 the ones we want to preserve. */
5035 && (pass
5036 || (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all,
5037 regnum)
5038 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
5039 regnum))))
5041 int nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regnum, rld[r].mode);
5042 /* Avoid the problem where spilling a GENERAL_OR_FP_REG
5043 (on 68000) got us two FP regs. If NR is 1,
5044 we would reject both of them. */
5045 if (force_group)
5046 nr = rld[r].nregs;
5047 /* If we need only one reg, we have already won. */
5048 if (nr == 1)
5050 /* But reject a single reg if we demand a group. */
5051 if (force_group)
5052 continue;
5053 break;
5055 /* Otherwise check that as many consecutive regs as we need
5056 are available here. */
5057 while (nr > 1)
5059 int regno = regnum + nr - 1;
5060 if (!(TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], regno)
5061 && spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0
5062 && reload_reg_free_p (regno, rld[r].opnum,
5063 rld[r].when_needed)))
5064 break;
5065 nr--;
5067 if (nr == 1)
5068 break;
5072 /* If we found something on pass 1, omit pass 2. */
5073 if (count < n_spills)
5074 break;
5077 /* We should have found a spill register by now. */
5078 if (count >= n_spills)
5079 return 0;
5081 /* I is the index in SPILL_REG_RTX of the reload register we are to
5082 allocate. Get an rtx for it and find its register number. */
5084 return set_reload_reg (i, r);
5087 /* Initialize all the tables needed to allocate reload registers.
5088 CHAIN is the insn currently being processed; SAVE_RELOAD_REG_RTX
5089 is the array we use to restore the reg_rtx field for every reload. */
5091 static void
5092 choose_reload_regs_init (chain, save_reload_reg_rtx)
5093 struct insn_chain *chain;
5094 rtx *save_reload_reg_rtx;
5096 int i;
5098 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5099 rld[i].reg_rtx = save_reload_reg_rtx[i];
5101 memset (reload_inherited, 0, MAX_RELOADS);
5102 memset ((char *) reload_inheritance_insn, 0, MAX_RELOADS * sizeof (rtx));
5103 memset ((char *) reload_override_in, 0, MAX_RELOADS * sizeof (rtx));
5105 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used);
5106 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_at_all);
5107 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr);
5108 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload);
5109 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_insn);
5110 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr);
5112 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn);
5114 HARD_REG_SET tmp;
5115 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (tmp, &chain->live_throughout);
5116 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn, tmp);
5117 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (tmp, &chain->dead_or_set);
5118 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn, tmp);
5119 compute_use_by_pseudos (&reg_used_in_insn, &chain->live_throughout);
5120 compute_use_by_pseudos (&reg_used_in_insn, &chain->dead_or_set);
5123 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5125 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output[i]);
5126 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input[i]);
5127 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i]);
5128 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i]);
5129 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i]);
5130 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i]);
5133 COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_unavailable, chain->used_spill_regs);
5135 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_for_inherit);
5137 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5138 /* If we have already decided to use a certain register,
5139 don't use it in another way. */
5140 if (rld[i].reg_rtx)
5141 mark_reload_reg_in_use (REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx), rld[i].opnum,
5142 rld[i].when_needed, rld[i].mode);
5145 /* Assign hard reg targets for the pseudo-registers we must reload
5146 into hard regs for this insn.
5147 Also output the instructions to copy them in and out of the hard regs.
5149 For machines with register classes, we are responsible for
5150 finding a reload reg in the proper class. */
5152 static void
5153 choose_reload_regs (chain)
5154 struct insn_chain *chain;
5156 rtx insn = chain->insn;
5157 register int i, j;
5158 unsigned int max_group_size = 1;
5159 enum reg_class group_class = NO_REGS;
5160 int pass, win, inheritance;
5162 rtx save_reload_reg_rtx[MAX_RELOADS];
5164 /* In order to be certain of getting the registers we need,
5165 we must sort the reloads into order of increasing register class.
5166 Then our grabbing of reload registers will parallel the process
5167 that provided the reload registers.
5169 Also note whether any of the reloads wants a consecutive group of regs.
5170 If so, record the maximum size of the group desired and what
5171 register class contains all the groups needed by this insn. */
5173 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5175 reload_order[j] = j;
5176 reload_spill_index[j] = -1;
5178 if (rld[j].nregs > 1)
5180 max_group_size = MAX (rld[j].nregs, max_group_size);
5181 group_class
5182 = reg_class_superunion[(int) rld[j].class][(int)group_class];
5185 save_reload_reg_rtx[j] = rld[j].reg_rtx;
5188 if (n_reloads > 1)
5189 qsort (reload_order, n_reloads, sizeof (short), reload_reg_class_lower);
5191 /* If -O, try first with inheritance, then turning it off.
5192 If not -O, don't do inheritance.
5193 Using inheritance when not optimizing leads to paradoxes
5194 with fp on the 68k: fp numbers (not NaNs) fail to be equal to themselves
5195 because one side of the comparison might be inherited. */
5196 win = 0;
5197 for (inheritance = optimize > 0; inheritance >= 0; inheritance--)
5199 choose_reload_regs_init (chain, save_reload_reg_rtx);
5201 /* Process the reloads in order of preference just found.
5202 Beyond this point, subregs can be found in reload_reg_rtx.
5204 This used to look for an existing reloaded home for all of the
5205 reloads, and only then perform any new reloads. But that could lose
5206 if the reloads were done out of reg-class order because a later
5207 reload with a looser constraint might have an old home in a register
5208 needed by an earlier reload with a tighter constraint.
5210 To solve this, we make two passes over the reloads, in the order
5211 described above. In the first pass we try to inherit a reload
5212 from a previous insn. If there is a later reload that needs a
5213 class that is a proper subset of the class being processed, we must
5214 also allocate a spill register during the first pass.
5216 Then make a second pass over the reloads to allocate any reloads
5217 that haven't been given registers yet. */
5219 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5221 register int r = reload_order[j];
5222 rtx search_equiv = NULL_RTX;
5224 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
5225 if (rld[r].out == 0 && rld[r].in == 0
5226 && ! rld[r].secondary_p)
5227 continue;
5229 /* If find_reloads chose to use reload_in or reload_out as a reload
5230 register, we don't need to chose one. Otherwise, try even if it
5231 found one since we might save an insn if we find the value lying
5232 around.
5233 Try also when reload_in is a pseudo without a hard reg. */
5234 if (rld[r].in != 0 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0
5235 && (rtx_equal_p (rld[r].in, rld[r].reg_rtx)
5236 || (rtx_equal_p (rld[r].out, rld[r].reg_rtx)
5237 && GET_CODE (rld[r].in) != MEM
5238 && true_regnum (rld[r].in) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
5239 continue;
5241 #if 0 /* No longer needed for correct operation.
5242 It might give better code, or might not; worth an experiment? */
5243 /* If this is an optional reload, we can't inherit from earlier insns
5244 until we are sure that any non-optional reloads have been allocated.
5245 The following code takes advantage of the fact that optional reloads
5246 are at the end of reload_order. */
5247 if (rld[r].optional != 0)
5248 for (i = 0; i < j; i++)
5249 if ((rld[reload_order[i]].out != 0
5250 || rld[reload_order[i]].in != 0
5251 || rld[reload_order[i]].secondary_p)
5252 && ! rld[reload_order[i]].optional
5253 && rld[reload_order[i]].reg_rtx == 0)
5254 allocate_reload_reg (chain, reload_order[i], 0);
5255 #endif
5257 /* First see if this pseudo is already available as reloaded
5258 for a previous insn. We cannot try to inherit for reloads
5259 that are smaller than the maximum number of registers needed
5260 for groups unless the register we would allocate cannot be used
5261 for the groups.
5263 We could check here to see if this is a secondary reload for
5264 an object that is already in a register of the desired class.
5265 This would avoid the need for the secondary reload register.
5266 But this is complex because we can't easily determine what
5267 objects might want to be loaded via this reload. So let a
5268 register be allocated here. In `emit_reload_insns' we suppress
5269 one of the loads in the case described above. */
5271 if (inheritance)
5273 int word = 0;
5274 register int regno = -1;
5275 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
5277 if (rld[r].in == 0)
5279 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == REG)
5281 regno = REGNO (rld[r].in);
5282 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in);
5284 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == REG)
5286 regno = REGNO (rld[r].in_reg);
5287 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in_reg);
5289 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == SUBREG
5290 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in_reg)) == REG)
5292 word = SUBREG_WORD (rld[r].in_reg);
5293 regno = REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in_reg));
5294 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5295 regno += word;
5296 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in_reg);
5298 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
5299 else if ((GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == PRE_INC
5300 || GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == PRE_DEC
5301 || GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == POST_INC
5302 || GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == POST_DEC)
5303 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0)) == REG)
5305 regno = REGNO (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
5306 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
5307 rld[r].out = rld[r].in;
5309 #endif
5310 #if 0
5311 /* This won't work, since REGNO can be a pseudo reg number.
5312 Also, it takes much more hair to keep track of all the things
5313 that can invalidate an inherited reload of part of a pseudoreg. */
5314 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == SUBREG
5315 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in)) == REG)
5316 regno = REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in)) + SUBREG_WORD (rld[r].in);
5317 #endif
5319 if (regno >= 0 && reg_last_reload_reg[regno] != 0)
5321 enum reg_class class = rld[r].class, last_class;
5322 rtx last_reg = reg_last_reload_reg[regno];
5323 enum machine_mode need_mode;
5325 i = REGNO (last_reg) + word;
5326 last_class = REGNO_REG_CLASS (i);
5328 if (word == 0)
5329 need_mode = mode;
5330 else
5331 need_mode
5332 = smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
5333 + word * UNITS_PER_WORD,
5334 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode));
5336 if (
5337 #ifdef CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE
5338 (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT
5339 (reg_class_contents[(int) CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE], i)
5340 ? ! CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P (GET_MODE (last_reg),
5341 need_mode)
5342 : (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (last_reg))
5343 >= GET_MODE_SIZE (need_mode)))
5344 #else
5345 (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (last_reg))
5346 >= GET_MODE_SIZE (need_mode))
5347 #endif
5348 && reg_reloaded_contents[i] == regno
5349 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i)
5350 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (i, rld[r].mode)
5351 && (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) class], i)
5352 /* Even if we can't use this register as a reload
5353 register, we might use it for reload_override_in,
5354 if copying it to the desired class is cheap
5355 enough. */
5356 || ((REGISTER_MOVE_COST (last_class, class)
5357 < MEMORY_MOVE_COST (mode, class, 1))
5358 #ifdef SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
5359 && (SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (class, mode,
5360 last_reg)
5361 == NO_REGS)
5362 #endif
5363 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
5364 && ! SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (last_class, class,
5365 mode)
5366 #endif
5369 && (rld[r].nregs == max_group_size
5370 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) group_class],
5372 && reload_reg_free_for_value_p (i, rld[r].opnum,
5373 rld[r].when_needed,
5374 rld[r].in,
5375 const0_rtx, r, 1))
5377 /* If a group is needed, verify that all the subsequent
5378 registers still have their values intact. */
5379 int nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i, rld[r].mode);
5380 int k;
5382 for (k = 1; k < nr; k++)
5383 if (reg_reloaded_contents[i + k] != regno
5384 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k))
5385 break;
5387 if (k == nr)
5389 int i1;
5391 last_reg = (GET_MODE (last_reg) == mode
5392 ? last_reg : gen_rtx_REG (mode, i));
5394 /* We found a register that contains the
5395 value we need. If this register is the
5396 same as an `earlyclobber' operand of the
5397 current insn, just mark it as a place to
5398 reload from since we can't use it as the
5399 reload register itself. */
5401 for (i1 = 0; i1 < n_earlyclobbers; i1++)
5402 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p
5403 (reg_last_reload_reg[regno],
5404 reload_earlyclobbers[i1]))
5405 break;
5407 if (i1 != n_earlyclobbers
5408 || ! (reload_reg_free_for_value_p
5409 (i, rld[r].opnum, rld[r].when_needed,
5410 rld[r].in, rld[r].out, r, 1))
5411 /* Don't use it if we'd clobber a pseudo reg. */
5412 || (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_used_in_insn, i)
5413 && rld[r].out
5414 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, i))
5415 /* Don't clobber the frame pointer. */
5416 || (i == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
5417 && rld[r].out)
5418 /* Don't really use the inherited spill reg
5419 if we need it wider than we've got it. */
5420 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (rld[r].mode)
5421 > GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
5422 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) rld[r].class],
5425 /* If find_reloads chose reload_out as reload
5426 register, stay with it - that leaves the
5427 inherited register for subsequent reloads. */
5428 || (rld[r].out && rld[r].reg_rtx
5429 && rtx_equal_p (rld[r].out, rld[r].reg_rtx)))
5431 if (! rld[r].optional)
5433 reload_override_in[r] = last_reg;
5434 reload_inheritance_insn[r]
5435 = reg_reloaded_insn[i];
5438 else
5440 int k;
5441 /* We can use this as a reload reg. */
5442 /* Mark the register as in use for this part of
5443 the insn. */
5444 mark_reload_reg_in_use (i,
5445 rld[r].opnum,
5446 rld[r].when_needed,
5447 rld[r].mode);
5448 rld[r].reg_rtx = last_reg;
5449 reload_inherited[r] = 1;
5450 reload_inheritance_insn[r]
5451 = reg_reloaded_insn[i];
5452 reload_spill_index[r] = i;
5453 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
5454 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
5455 i + k);
5462 /* Here's another way to see if the value is already lying around. */
5463 if (inheritance
5464 && rld[r].in != 0
5465 && ! reload_inherited[r]
5466 && rld[r].out == 0
5467 && (CONSTANT_P (rld[r].in)
5468 || GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == PLUS
5469 || GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == REG
5470 || GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == MEM)
5471 && (rld[r].nregs == max_group_size
5472 || ! reg_classes_intersect_p (rld[r].class, group_class)))
5473 search_equiv = rld[r].in;
5474 /* If this is an output reload from a simple move insn, look
5475 if an equivalence for the input is available. */
5476 else if (inheritance && rld[r].in == 0 && rld[r].out != 0)
5478 rtx set = single_set (insn);
5480 if (set
5481 && rtx_equal_p (rld[r].out, SET_DEST (set))
5482 && CONSTANT_P (SET_SRC (set)))
5483 search_equiv = SET_SRC (set);
5486 if (search_equiv)
5488 register rtx equiv
5489 = find_equiv_reg (search_equiv, insn, rld[r].class,
5490 -1, NULL_PTR, 0, rld[r].mode);
5491 int regno = 0;
5493 if (equiv != 0)
5495 if (GET_CODE (equiv) == REG)
5496 regno = REGNO (equiv);
5497 else if (GET_CODE (equiv) == SUBREG)
5499 /* This must be a SUBREG of a hard register.
5500 Make a new REG since this might be used in an
5501 address and not all machines support SUBREGs
5502 there. */
5503 regno = REGNO (SUBREG_REG (equiv)) + SUBREG_WORD (equiv);
5504 equiv = gen_rtx_REG (rld[r].mode, regno);
5506 else
5507 abort ();
5510 /* If we found a spill reg, reject it unless it is free
5511 and of the desired class. */
5512 if (equiv != 0
5513 && ((TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all, regno)
5514 && ! reload_reg_free_for_value_p (regno, rld[r].opnum,
5515 rld[r].when_needed,
5516 rld[r].in,
5517 rld[r].out, r, 1))
5518 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) rld[r].class],
5519 regno)))
5520 equiv = 0;
5522 if (equiv != 0 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rld[r].mode))
5523 equiv = 0;
5525 /* We found a register that contains the value we need.
5526 If this register is the same as an `earlyclobber' operand
5527 of the current insn, just mark it as a place to reload from
5528 since we can't use it as the reload register itself. */
5530 if (equiv != 0)
5531 for (i = 0; i < n_earlyclobbers; i++)
5532 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (equiv,
5533 reload_earlyclobbers[i]))
5535 if (! rld[r].optional)
5536 reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
5537 equiv = 0;
5538 break;
5541 /* If the equiv register we have found is explicitly clobbered
5542 in the current insn, it depends on the reload type if we
5543 can use it, use it for reload_override_in, or not at all.
5544 In particular, we then can't use EQUIV for a
5545 RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload. */
5547 if (equiv != 0 && regno_clobbered_p (regno, insn, rld[r].mode))
5549 switch (rld[r].when_needed)
5551 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5552 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5553 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5554 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5555 break;
5556 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5557 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5558 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5559 if (! rld[r].optional)
5560 reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
5561 /* Fall through. */
5562 default:
5563 equiv = 0;
5564 break;
5568 /* If we found an equivalent reg, say no code need be generated
5569 to load it, and use it as our reload reg. */
5570 if (equiv != 0 && regno != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
5572 int nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, rld[r].mode);
5573 int k;
5574 rld[r].reg_rtx = equiv;
5575 reload_inherited[r] = 1;
5577 /* If reg_reloaded_valid is not set for this register,
5578 there might be a stale spill_reg_store lying around.
5579 We must clear it, since otherwise emit_reload_insns
5580 might delete the store. */
5581 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno))
5582 spill_reg_store[regno] = NULL_RTX;
5583 /* If any of the hard registers in EQUIV are spill
5584 registers, mark them as in use for this insn. */
5585 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
5587 i = spill_reg_order[regno + k];
5588 if (i >= 0)
5590 mark_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[r].opnum,
5591 rld[r].when_needed,
5592 rld[r].mode);
5593 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
5594 regno + k);
5600 /* If we found a register to use already, or if this is an optional
5601 reload, we are done. */
5602 if (rld[r].reg_rtx != 0 || rld[r].optional != 0)
5603 continue;
5605 #if 0
5606 /* No longer needed for correct operation. Might or might
5607 not give better code on the average. Want to experiment? */
5609 /* See if there is a later reload that has a class different from our
5610 class that intersects our class or that requires less register
5611 than our reload. If so, we must allocate a register to this
5612 reload now, since that reload might inherit a previous reload
5613 and take the only available register in our class. Don't do this
5614 for optional reloads since they will force all previous reloads
5615 to be allocated. Also don't do this for reloads that have been
5616 turned off. */
5618 for (i = j + 1; i < n_reloads; i++)
5620 int s = reload_order[i];
5622 if ((rld[s].in == 0 && rld[s].out == 0
5623 && ! rld[s].secondary_p)
5624 || rld[s].optional)
5625 continue;
5627 if ((rld[s].class != rld[r].class
5628 && reg_classes_intersect_p (rld[r].class,
5629 rld[s].class))
5630 || rld[s].nregs < rld[r].nregs)
5631 break;
5634 if (i == n_reloads)
5635 continue;
5637 allocate_reload_reg (chain, r, j == n_reloads - 1);
5638 #endif
5641 /* Now allocate reload registers for anything non-optional that
5642 didn't get one yet. */
5643 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5645 register int r = reload_order[j];
5647 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
5648 if (rld[r].out == 0 && rld[r].in == 0 && ! rld[r].secondary_p)
5649 continue;
5651 /* Skip reloads that already have a register allocated or are
5652 optional. */
5653 if (rld[r].reg_rtx != 0 || rld[r].optional)
5654 continue;
5656 if (! allocate_reload_reg (chain, r, j == n_reloads - 1))
5657 break;
5660 /* If that loop got all the way, we have won. */
5661 if (j == n_reloads)
5663 win = 1;
5664 break;
5667 /* Loop around and try without any inheritance. */
5670 if (! win)
5672 /* First undo everything done by the failed attempt
5673 to allocate with inheritance. */
5674 choose_reload_regs_init (chain, save_reload_reg_rtx);
5676 /* Some sanity tests to verify that the reloads found in the first
5677 pass are identical to the ones we have now. */
5678 if (chain->n_reloads != n_reloads)
5679 abort ();
5681 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5683 if (chain->rld[i].regno < 0 || chain->rld[i].reg_rtx != 0)
5684 continue;
5685 if (chain->rld[i].when_needed != rld[i].when_needed)
5686 abort ();
5687 for (j = 0; j < n_spills; j++)
5688 if (spill_regs[j] == chain->rld[i].regno)
5689 if (! set_reload_reg (j, i))
5690 failed_reload (chain->insn, i);
5694 /* If we thought we could inherit a reload, because it seemed that
5695 nothing else wanted the same reload register earlier in the insn,
5696 verify that assumption, now that all reloads have been assigned.
5697 Likewise for reloads where reload_override_in has been set. */
5699 /* If doing expensive optimizations, do one preliminary pass that doesn't
5700 cancel any inheritance, but removes reloads that have been needed only
5701 for reloads that we know can be inherited. */
5702 for (pass = flag_expensive_optimizations; pass >= 0; pass--)
5704 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5706 register int r = reload_order[j];
5707 rtx check_reg;
5708 if (reload_inherited[r] && rld[r].reg_rtx)
5709 check_reg = rld[r].reg_rtx;
5710 else if (reload_override_in[r]
5711 && (GET_CODE (reload_override_in[r]) == REG
5712 || GET_CODE (reload_override_in[r]) == SUBREG))
5713 check_reg = reload_override_in[r];
5714 else
5715 continue;
5716 if (! reload_reg_free_for_value_p (true_regnum (check_reg),
5717 rld[r].opnum,
5718 rld[r].when_needed,
5719 rld[r].in,
5720 (reload_inherited[r]
5721 ? rld[r].out : const0_rtx),
5722 r, 1))
5724 if (pass)
5725 continue;
5726 reload_inherited[r] = 0;
5727 reload_override_in[r] = 0;
5729 /* If we can inherit a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT, or can use a
5730 reload_override_in, then we do not need its related
5731 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS / RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reloads;
5732 likewise for other reload types.
5733 We handle this by removing a reload when its only replacement
5734 is mentioned in reload_in of the reload we are going to inherit.
5735 A special case are auto_inc expressions; even if the input is
5736 inherited, we still need the address for the output. We can
5737 recognize them because they have RELOAD_OUT set to RELOAD_IN.
5738 If we suceeded removing some reload and we are doing a preliminary
5739 pass just to remove such reloads, make another pass, since the
5740 removal of one reload might allow us to inherit another one. */
5741 else if (rld[r].in
5742 && rld[r].out != rld[r].in
5743 && remove_address_replacements (rld[r].in) && pass)
5744 pass = 2;
5748 /* Now that reload_override_in is known valid,
5749 actually override reload_in. */
5750 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5751 if (reload_override_in[j])
5752 rld[j].in = reload_override_in[j];
5754 /* If this reload won't be done because it has been cancelled or is
5755 optional and not inherited, clear reload_reg_rtx so other
5756 routines (such as subst_reloads) don't get confused. */
5757 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5758 if (rld[j].reg_rtx != 0
5759 && ((rld[j].optional && ! reload_inherited[j])
5760 || (rld[j].in == 0 && rld[j].out == 0
5761 && ! rld[j].secondary_p)))
5763 int regno = true_regnum (rld[j].reg_rtx);
5765 if (spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0)
5766 clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[j].opnum,
5767 rld[j].when_needed, rld[j].mode);
5768 rld[j].reg_rtx = 0;
5769 reload_spill_index[j] = -1;
5772 /* Record which pseudos and which spill regs have output reloads. */
5773 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5775 register int r = reload_order[j];
5777 i = reload_spill_index[r];
5779 /* I is nonneg if this reload uses a register.
5780 If rld[r].reg_rtx is 0, this is an optional reload
5781 that we opted to ignore. */
5782 if (rld[r].out_reg != 0 && GET_CODE (rld[r].out_reg) == REG
5783 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0)
5785 register int nregno = REGNO (rld[r].out_reg);
5786 int nr = 1;
5788 if (nregno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5789 nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (nregno, rld[r].mode);
5791 while (--nr >= 0)
5792 reg_has_output_reload[nregno + nr] = 1;
5794 if (i >= 0)
5796 nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i, rld[r].mode);
5797 while (--nr >= 0)
5798 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, i + nr);
5801 if (rld[r].when_needed != RELOAD_OTHER
5802 && rld[r].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
5803 && rld[r].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_INSN)
5804 abort ();
5809 /* Deallocate the reload register for reload R. This is called from
5810 remove_address_replacements. */
5812 void
5813 deallocate_reload_reg (r)
5814 int r;
5816 int regno;
5818 if (! rld[r].reg_rtx)
5819 return;
5820 regno = true_regnum (rld[r].reg_rtx);
5821 rld[r].reg_rtx = 0;
5822 if (spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0)
5823 clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[r].opnum, rld[r].when_needed,
5824 rld[r].mode);
5825 reload_spill_index[r] = -1;
5828 /* If SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES is non-zero, we may not have merged two
5829 reloads of the same item for fear that we might not have enough reload
5830 registers. However, normally they will get the same reload register
5831 and hence actually need not be loaded twice.
5833 Here we check for the most common case of this phenomenon: when we have
5834 a number of reloads for the same object, each of which were allocated
5835 the same reload_reg_rtx, that reload_reg_rtx is not used for any other
5836 reload, and is not modified in the insn itself. If we find such,
5837 merge all the reloads and set the resulting reload to RELOAD_OTHER.
5838 This will not increase the number of spill registers needed and will
5839 prevent redundant code. */
5841 static void
5842 merge_assigned_reloads (insn)
5843 rtx insn;
5845 int i, j;
5847 /* Scan all the reloads looking for ones that only load values and
5848 are not already RELOAD_OTHER and ones whose reload_reg_rtx are
5849 assigned and not modified by INSN. */
5851 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5853 int conflicting_input = 0;
5854 int max_input_address_opnum = -1;
5855 int min_conflicting_input_opnum = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS;
5857 if (rld[i].in == 0 || rld[i].when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER
5858 || rld[i].out != 0 || rld[i].reg_rtx == 0
5859 || reg_set_p (rld[i].reg_rtx, insn))
5860 continue;
5862 /* Look at all other reloads. Ensure that the only use of this
5863 reload_reg_rtx is in a reload that just loads the same value
5864 as we do. Note that any secondary reloads must be of the identical
5865 class since the values, modes, and result registers are the
5866 same, so we need not do anything with any secondary reloads. */
5868 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5870 if (i == j || rld[j].reg_rtx == 0
5871 || ! reg_overlap_mentioned_p (rld[j].reg_rtx,
5872 rld[i].reg_rtx))
5873 continue;
5875 if (rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
5876 && rld[j].opnum > max_input_address_opnum)
5877 max_input_address_opnum = rld[j].opnum;
5879 /* If the reload regs aren't exactly the same (e.g, different modes)
5880 or if the values are different, we can't merge this reload.
5881 But if it is an input reload, we might still merge
5882 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reloads. */
5884 if (! rtx_equal_p (rld[i].reg_rtx, rld[j].reg_rtx)
5885 || rld[j].out != 0 || rld[j].in == 0
5886 || ! rtx_equal_p (rld[i].in, rld[j].in))
5888 if (rld[j].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
5889 || ((rld[i].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
5890 || rld[i].opnum > rld[j].opnum)
5891 && rld[i].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS))
5892 break;
5893 conflicting_input = 1;
5894 if (min_conflicting_input_opnum > rld[j].opnum)
5895 min_conflicting_input_opnum = rld[j].opnum;
5899 /* If all is OK, merge the reloads. Only set this to RELOAD_OTHER if
5900 we, in fact, found any matching reloads. */
5902 if (j == n_reloads
5903 && max_input_address_opnum <= min_conflicting_input_opnum)
5905 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5906 if (i != j && rld[j].reg_rtx != 0
5907 && rtx_equal_p (rld[i].reg_rtx, rld[j].reg_rtx)
5908 && (! conflicting_input
5909 || rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
5910 || rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS))
5912 rld[i].when_needed = RELOAD_OTHER;
5913 rld[j].in = 0;
5914 reload_spill_index[j] = -1;
5915 transfer_replacements (i, j);
5918 /* If this is now RELOAD_OTHER, look for any reloads that load
5919 parts of this operand and set them to RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
5920 if they were for inputs, RELOAD_OTHER for outputs. Note that
5921 this test is equivalent to looking for reloads for this operand
5922 number. */
5924 if (rld[i].when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER)
5925 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5926 if (rld[j].in != 0
5927 && rld[i].when_needed != RELOAD_OTHER
5928 && reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (rld[j].in,
5929 rld[i].in))
5930 rld[j].when_needed
5931 = ((rld[i].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
5932 || rld[i].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS)
5933 ? RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS : RELOAD_OTHER);
5938 /* These arrays are filled by emit_reload_insns and its subroutines. */
5939 static rtx input_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
5940 static rtx other_input_address_reload_insns = 0;
5941 static rtx other_input_reload_insns = 0;
5942 static rtx input_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
5943 static rtx inpaddr_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
5944 static rtx output_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
5945 static rtx output_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
5946 static rtx outaddr_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
5947 static rtx operand_reload_insns = 0;
5948 static rtx other_operand_reload_insns = 0;
5949 static rtx other_output_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
5951 /* Values to be put in spill_reg_store are put here first. */
5952 static rtx new_spill_reg_store[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
5953 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_died;
5955 /* Generate insns to perform reload RL, which is for the insn in CHAIN and
5956 has the number J. OLD contains the value to be used as input. */
5958 static void
5959 emit_input_reload_insns (chain, rl, old, j)
5960 struct insn_chain *chain;
5961 struct reload *rl;
5962 rtx old;
5963 int j;
5965 rtx insn = chain->insn;
5966 register rtx reloadreg = rl->reg_rtx;
5967 rtx oldequiv_reg = 0;
5968 rtx oldequiv = 0;
5969 int special = 0;
5970 enum machine_mode mode;
5971 rtx *where;
5973 /* Determine the mode to reload in.
5974 This is very tricky because we have three to choose from.
5975 There is the mode the insn operand wants (rl->inmode).
5976 There is the mode of the reload register RELOADREG.
5977 There is the intrinsic mode of the operand, which we could find
5978 by stripping some SUBREGs.
5979 It turns out that RELOADREG's mode is irrelevant:
5980 we can change that arbitrarily.
5982 Consider (SUBREG:SI foo:QI) as an operand that must be SImode;
5983 then the reload reg may not support QImode moves, so use SImode.
5984 If foo is in memory due to spilling a pseudo reg, this is safe,
5985 because the QImode value is in the least significant part of a
5986 slot big enough for a SImode. If foo is some other sort of
5987 memory reference, then it is impossible to reload this case,
5988 so previous passes had better make sure this never happens.
5990 Then consider a one-word union which has SImode and one of its
5991 members is a float, being fetched as (SUBREG:SF union:SI).
5992 We must fetch that as SFmode because we could be loading into
5993 a float-only register. In this case OLD's mode is correct.
5995 Consider an immediate integer: it has VOIDmode. Here we need
5996 to get a mode from something else.
5998 In some cases, there is a fourth mode, the operand's
5999 containing mode. If the insn specifies a containing mode for
6000 this operand, it overrides all others.
6002 I am not sure whether the algorithm here is always right,
6003 but it does the right things in those cases. */
6005 mode = GET_MODE (old);
6006 if (mode == VOIDmode)
6007 mode = rl->inmode;
6009 #ifdef SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
6010 /* If we need a secondary register for this operation, see if
6011 the value is already in a register in that class. Don't
6012 do this if the secondary register will be used as a scratch
6013 register. */
6015 if (rl->secondary_in_reload >= 0
6016 && rl->secondary_in_icode == CODE_FOR_nothing
6017 && optimize)
6018 oldequiv
6019 = find_equiv_reg (old, insn,
6020 rld[rl->secondary_in_reload].class,
6021 -1, NULL_PTR, 0, mode);
6022 #endif
6024 /* If reloading from memory, see if there is a register
6025 that already holds the same value. If so, reload from there.
6026 We can pass 0 as the reload_reg_p argument because
6027 any other reload has either already been emitted,
6028 in which case find_equiv_reg will see the reload-insn,
6029 or has yet to be emitted, in which case it doesn't matter
6030 because we will use this equiv reg right away. */
6032 if (oldequiv == 0 && optimize
6033 && (GET_CODE (old) == MEM
6034 || (GET_CODE (old) == REG
6035 && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6036 && reg_renumber[REGNO (old)] < 0)))
6037 oldequiv = find_equiv_reg (old, insn, ALL_REGS,
6038 -1, NULL_PTR, 0, mode);
6040 if (oldequiv)
6042 unsigned int regno = true_regnum (oldequiv);
6044 /* Don't use OLDEQUIV if any other reload changes it at an
6045 earlier stage of this insn or at this stage. */
6046 if (! reload_reg_free_for_value_p (regno, rl->opnum,
6047 rl->when_needed,
6048 rl->in, const0_rtx, j,
6050 oldequiv = 0;
6052 /* If it is no cheaper to copy from OLDEQUIV into the
6053 reload register than it would be to move from memory,
6054 don't use it. Likewise, if we need a secondary register
6055 or memory. */
6057 if (oldequiv != 0
6058 && ((REGNO_REG_CLASS (regno) != rl->class
6059 && (REGISTER_MOVE_COST (REGNO_REG_CLASS (regno),
6060 rl->class)
6061 >= MEMORY_MOVE_COST (mode, rl->class, 1)))
6062 #ifdef SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
6063 || (SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rl->class,
6064 mode, oldequiv)
6065 != NO_REGS)
6066 #endif
6067 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
6068 || SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (REGNO_REG_CLASS (regno),
6069 rl->class,
6070 mode)
6071 #endif
6073 oldequiv = 0;
6076 /* delete_output_reload is only invoked properly if old contains
6077 the original pseudo register. Since this is replaced with a
6078 hard reg when RELOAD_OVERRIDE_IN is set, see if we can
6079 find the pseudo in RELOAD_IN_REG. */
6080 if (oldequiv == 0
6081 && reload_override_in[j]
6082 && GET_CODE (rl->in_reg) == REG)
6084 oldequiv = old;
6085 old = rl->in_reg;
6087 if (oldequiv == 0)
6088 oldequiv = old;
6089 else if (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == REG)
6090 oldequiv_reg = oldequiv;
6091 else if (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG)
6092 oldequiv_reg = SUBREG_REG (oldequiv);
6094 /* If we are reloading from a register that was recently stored in
6095 with an output-reload, see if we can prove there was
6096 actually no need to store the old value in it. */
6098 if (optimize && GET_CODE (oldequiv) == REG
6099 && REGNO (oldequiv) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6100 && spill_reg_store[REGNO (oldequiv)]
6101 && GET_CODE (old) == REG
6102 && (dead_or_set_p (insn, spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)])
6103 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)],
6104 rl->out_reg)))
6105 delete_output_reload (insn, j, REGNO (oldequiv));
6107 /* Encapsulate both RELOADREG and OLDEQUIV into that mode,
6108 then load RELOADREG from OLDEQUIV. Note that we cannot use
6109 gen_lowpart_common since it can do the wrong thing when
6110 RELOADREG has a multi-word mode. Note that RELOADREG
6111 must always be a REG here. */
6113 if (GET_MODE (reloadreg) != mode)
6114 reloadreg = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (reloadreg));
6115 while (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG && GET_MODE (oldequiv) != mode)
6116 oldequiv = SUBREG_REG (oldequiv);
6117 if (GET_MODE (oldequiv) != VOIDmode
6118 && mode != GET_MODE (oldequiv))
6119 oldequiv = gen_rtx_SUBREG (mode, oldequiv, 0);
6121 /* Switch to the right place to emit the reload insns. */
6122 switch (rl->when_needed)
6124 case RELOAD_OTHER:
6125 where = &other_input_reload_insns;
6126 break;
6127 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
6128 where = &input_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6129 break;
6130 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
6131 where = &input_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6132 break;
6133 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
6134 where = &inpaddr_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6135 break;
6136 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
6137 where = &output_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6138 break;
6139 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
6140 where = &outaddr_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6141 break;
6142 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
6143 where = &operand_reload_insns;
6144 break;
6145 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
6146 where = &other_operand_reload_insns;
6147 break;
6148 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
6149 where = &other_input_address_reload_insns;
6150 break;
6151 default:
6152 abort ();
6155 push_to_sequence (*where);
6157 /* Auto-increment addresses must be reloaded in a special way. */
6158 if (rl->out && ! rl->out_reg)
6160 /* We are not going to bother supporting the case where a
6161 incremented register can't be copied directly from
6162 OLDEQUIV since this seems highly unlikely. */
6163 if (rl->secondary_in_reload >= 0)
6164 abort ();
6166 if (reload_inherited[j])
6167 oldequiv = reloadreg;
6169 old = XEXP (rl->in_reg, 0);
6171 if (optimize && GET_CODE (oldequiv) == REG
6172 && REGNO (oldequiv) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6173 && spill_reg_store[REGNO (oldequiv)]
6174 && GET_CODE (old) == REG
6175 && (dead_or_set_p (insn,
6176 spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)])
6177 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)],
6178 old)))
6179 delete_output_reload (insn, j, REGNO (oldequiv));
6181 /* Prevent normal processing of this reload. */
6182 special = 1;
6183 /* Output a special code sequence for this case. */
6184 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (reloadreg)]
6185 = inc_for_reload (reloadreg, oldequiv, rl->out,
6186 rl->inc);
6189 /* If we are reloading a pseudo-register that was set by the previous
6190 insn, see if we can get rid of that pseudo-register entirely
6191 by redirecting the previous insn into our reload register. */
6193 else if (optimize && GET_CODE (old) == REG
6194 && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6195 && dead_or_set_p (insn, old)
6196 /* This is unsafe if some other reload
6197 uses the same reg first. */
6198 && reload_reg_free_for_value_p (REGNO (reloadreg),
6199 rl->opnum,
6200 rl->when_needed,
6201 old, rl->out,
6202 j, 0))
6204 rtx temp = PREV_INSN (insn);
6205 while (temp && GET_CODE (temp) == NOTE)
6206 temp = PREV_INSN (temp);
6207 if (temp
6208 && GET_CODE (temp) == INSN
6209 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (temp)) == SET
6210 && SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) == old
6211 /* Make sure we can access insn_operand_constraint. */
6212 && asm_noperands (PATTERN (temp)) < 0
6213 /* This is unsafe if prev insn rejects our reload reg. */
6214 && constraint_accepts_reg_p (insn_data[recog_memoized (temp)].operand[0].constraint,
6215 reloadreg)
6216 /* This is unsafe if operand occurs more than once in current
6217 insn. Perhaps some occurrences aren't reloaded. */
6218 && count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), old, 0) == 1
6219 /* Don't risk splitting a matching pair of operands. */
6220 && ! reg_mentioned_p (old, SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp))))
6222 /* Store into the reload register instead of the pseudo. */
6223 SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) = reloadreg;
6225 /* If the previous insn is an output reload, the source is
6226 a reload register, and its spill_reg_store entry will
6227 contain the previous destination. This is now
6228 invalid. */
6229 if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp))) == REG
6230 && REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp))) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6232 spill_reg_store[REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp)))] = 0;
6233 spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp)))] = 0;
6236 /* If these are the only uses of the pseudo reg,
6237 pretend for GDB it lives in the reload reg we used. */
6238 if (REG_N_DEATHS (REGNO (old)) == 1
6239 && REG_N_SETS (REGNO (old)) == 1)
6241 reg_renumber[REGNO (old)] = REGNO (rl->reg_rtx);
6242 alter_reg (REGNO (old), -1);
6244 special = 1;
6248 /* We can't do that, so output an insn to load RELOADREG. */
6250 #ifdef SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
6251 /* If we have a secondary reload, pick up the secondary register
6252 and icode, if any. If OLDEQUIV and OLD are different or
6253 if this is an in-out reload, recompute whether or not we
6254 still need a secondary register and what the icode should
6255 be. If we still need a secondary register and the class or
6256 icode is different, go back to reloading from OLD if using
6257 OLDEQUIV means that we got the wrong type of register. We
6258 cannot have different class or icode due to an in-out reload
6259 because we don't make such reloads when both the input and
6260 output need secondary reload registers. */
6262 if (! special && rl->secondary_in_reload >= 0)
6264 rtx second_reload_reg = 0;
6265 int secondary_reload = rl->secondary_in_reload;
6266 rtx real_oldequiv = oldequiv;
6267 rtx real_old = old;
6268 rtx tmp;
6269 enum insn_code icode;
6271 /* If OLDEQUIV is a pseudo with a MEM, get the real MEM
6272 and similarly for OLD.
6273 See comments in get_secondary_reload in reload.c. */
6274 /* If it is a pseudo that cannot be replaced with its
6275 equivalent MEM, we must fall back to reload_in, which
6276 will have all the necessary substitutions registered.
6277 Likewise for a pseudo that can't be replaced with its
6278 equivalent constant.
6280 Take extra care for subregs of such pseudos. Note that
6281 we cannot use reg_equiv_mem in this case because it is
6282 not in the right mode. */
6284 tmp = oldequiv;
6285 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG)
6286 tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp);
6287 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG
6288 && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6289 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (tmp)] != 0
6290 || reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (tmp)] != 0))
6292 if (! reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)]
6293 || num_not_at_initial_offset
6294 || GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG)
6295 real_oldequiv = rl->in;
6296 else
6297 real_oldequiv = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)];
6300 tmp = old;
6301 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG)
6302 tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp);
6303 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG
6304 && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6305 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (tmp)] != 0
6306 || reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (tmp)] != 0))
6308 if (! reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)]
6309 || num_not_at_initial_offset
6310 || GET_CODE (old) == SUBREG)
6311 real_old = rl->in;
6312 else
6313 real_old = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)];
6316 second_reload_reg = rld[secondary_reload].reg_rtx;
6317 icode = rl->secondary_in_icode;
6319 if ((old != oldequiv && ! rtx_equal_p (old, oldequiv))
6320 || (rl->in != 0 && rl->out != 0))
6322 enum reg_class new_class
6323 = SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rl->class,
6324 mode, real_oldequiv);
6326 if (new_class == NO_REGS)
6327 second_reload_reg = 0;
6328 else
6330 enum insn_code new_icode;
6331 enum machine_mode new_mode;
6333 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) new_class],
6334 REGNO (second_reload_reg)))
6335 oldequiv = old, real_oldequiv = real_old;
6336 else
6338 new_icode = reload_in_optab[(int) mode];
6339 if (new_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing
6340 && ((insn_data[(int) new_icode].operand[0].predicate
6341 && ! ((*insn_data[(int) new_icode].operand[0].predicate)
6342 (reloadreg, mode)))
6343 || (insn_data[(int) new_icode].operand[1].predicate
6344 && ! ((*insn_data[(int) new_icode].operand[1].predicate)
6345 (real_oldequiv, mode)))))
6346 new_icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
6348 if (new_icode == CODE_FOR_nothing)
6349 new_mode = mode;
6350 else
6351 new_mode = insn_data[(int) new_icode].operand[2].mode;
6353 if (GET_MODE (second_reload_reg) != new_mode)
6355 if (!HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (second_reload_reg),
6356 new_mode))
6357 oldequiv = old, real_oldequiv = real_old;
6358 else
6359 second_reload_reg
6360 = gen_rtx_REG (new_mode,
6361 REGNO (second_reload_reg));
6367 /* If we still need a secondary reload register, check
6368 to see if it is being used as a scratch or intermediate
6369 register and generate code appropriately. If we need
6370 a scratch register, use REAL_OLDEQUIV since the form of
6371 the insn may depend on the actual address if it is
6372 a MEM. */
6374 if (second_reload_reg)
6376 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6378 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (reloadreg, real_oldequiv,
6379 second_reload_reg));
6380 special = 1;
6382 else
6384 /* See if we need a scratch register to load the
6385 intermediate register (a tertiary reload). */
6386 enum insn_code tertiary_icode
6387 = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_in_icode;
6389 if (tertiary_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6391 rtx third_reload_reg
6392 = rld[rld[secondary_reload].secondary_in_reload].reg_rtx;
6394 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (tertiary_icode)
6395 (second_reload_reg, real_oldequiv,
6396 third_reload_reg)));
6398 else
6399 gen_reload (second_reload_reg, real_oldequiv,
6400 rl->opnum,
6401 rl->when_needed);
6403 oldequiv = second_reload_reg;
6407 #endif
6409 if (! special && ! rtx_equal_p (reloadreg, oldequiv))
6411 rtx real_oldequiv = oldequiv;
6413 if ((GET_CODE (oldequiv) == REG
6414 && REGNO (oldequiv) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6415 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (oldequiv)] != 0
6416 || reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (oldequiv)] != 0))
6417 || (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG
6418 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv)) == REG
6419 && (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))
6420 >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6421 && ((reg_equiv_memory_loc
6422 [REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))] != 0)
6423 || (reg_equiv_constant
6424 [REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))] != 0))))
6425 real_oldequiv = rl->in;
6426 gen_reload (reloadreg, real_oldequiv, rl->opnum,
6427 rl->when_needed);
6430 /* End this sequence. */
6431 *where = get_insns ();
6432 end_sequence ();
6434 /* Update reload_override_in so that delete_address_reloads_1
6435 can see the actual register usage. */
6436 if (oldequiv_reg)
6437 reload_override_in[j] = oldequiv;
6440 /* Generate insns to for the output reload RL, which is for the insn described
6441 by CHAIN and has the number J. */
6442 static void
6443 emit_output_reload_insns (chain, rl, j)
6444 struct insn_chain *chain;
6445 struct reload *rl;
6446 int j;
6448 rtx reloadreg = rl->reg_rtx;
6449 rtx insn = chain->insn;
6450 int special = 0;
6451 rtx old = rl->out;
6452 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (old);
6453 rtx p;
6455 if (rl->when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER)
6456 start_sequence ();
6457 else
6458 push_to_sequence (output_reload_insns[rl->opnum]);
6460 /* Determine the mode to reload in.
6461 See comments above (for input reloading). */
6463 if (mode == VOIDmode)
6465 /* VOIDmode should never happen for an output. */
6466 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) < 0)
6467 /* It's the compiler's fault. */
6468 fatal_insn ("VOIDmode on an output", insn);
6469 error_for_asm (insn, "output operand is constant in `asm'");
6470 /* Prevent crash--use something we know is valid. */
6471 mode = word_mode;
6472 old = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (reloadreg));
6475 if (GET_MODE (reloadreg) != mode)
6476 reloadreg = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (reloadreg));
6478 #ifdef SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
6480 /* If we need two reload regs, set RELOADREG to the intermediate
6481 one, since it will be stored into OLD. We might need a secondary
6482 register only for an input reload, so check again here. */
6484 if (rl->secondary_out_reload >= 0)
6486 rtx real_old = old;
6488 if (GET_CODE (old) == REG && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6489 && reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (old)] != 0)
6490 real_old = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (old)];
6492 if ((SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rl->class,
6493 mode, real_old)
6494 != NO_REGS))
6496 rtx second_reloadreg = reloadreg;
6497 reloadreg = rld[rl->secondary_out_reload].reg_rtx;
6499 /* See if RELOADREG is to be used as a scratch register
6500 or as an intermediate register. */
6501 if (rl->secondary_out_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6503 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (rl->secondary_out_icode)
6504 (real_old, second_reloadreg, reloadreg)));
6505 special = 1;
6507 else
6509 /* See if we need both a scratch and intermediate reload
6510 register. */
6512 int secondary_reload = rl->secondary_out_reload;
6513 enum insn_code tertiary_icode
6514 = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_out_icode;
6516 if (GET_MODE (reloadreg) != mode)
6517 reloadreg = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (reloadreg));
6519 if (tertiary_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6521 rtx third_reloadreg
6522 = rld[rld[secondary_reload].secondary_out_reload].reg_rtx;
6523 rtx tem;
6525 /* Copy primary reload reg to secondary reload reg.
6526 (Note that these have been swapped above, then
6527 secondary reload reg to OLD using our insn. */
6529 /* If REAL_OLD is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it
6530 and try to put the opposite SUBREG on
6531 RELOADREG. */
6532 if (GET_CODE (real_old) == SUBREG
6533 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (real_old))
6534 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (real_old))))
6535 && 0 != (tem = gen_lowpart_common
6536 (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (real_old)),
6537 reloadreg)))
6538 real_old = SUBREG_REG (real_old), reloadreg = tem;
6540 gen_reload (reloadreg, second_reloadreg,
6541 rl->opnum, rl->when_needed);
6542 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (tertiary_icode)
6543 (real_old, reloadreg, third_reloadreg)));
6544 special = 1;
6547 else
6548 /* Copy between the reload regs here and then to
6549 OUT later. */
6551 gen_reload (reloadreg, second_reloadreg,
6552 rl->opnum, rl->when_needed);
6556 #endif
6558 /* Output the last reload insn. */
6559 if (! special)
6561 rtx set;
6563 /* Don't output the last reload if OLD is not the dest of
6564 INSN and is in the src and is clobbered by INSN. */
6565 if (! flag_expensive_optimizations
6566 || GET_CODE (old) != REG
6567 || !(set = single_set (insn))
6568 || rtx_equal_p (old, SET_DEST (set))
6569 || !reg_mentioned_p (old, SET_SRC (set))
6570 || !regno_clobbered_p (REGNO (old), insn, rl->mode))
6571 gen_reload (old, reloadreg, rl->opnum,
6572 rl->when_needed);
6575 /* Look at all insns we emitted, just to be safe. */
6576 for (p = get_insns (); p; p = NEXT_INSN (p))
6577 if (INSN_P (p))
6579 rtx pat = PATTERN (p);
6581 /* If this output reload doesn't come from a spill reg,
6582 clear any memory of reloaded copies of the pseudo reg.
6583 If this output reload comes from a spill reg,
6584 reg_has_output_reload will make this do nothing. */
6585 note_stores (pat, forget_old_reloads_1, NULL);
6587 if (reg_mentioned_p (rl->reg_rtx, pat))
6589 rtx set = single_set (insn);
6590 if (reload_spill_index[j] < 0
6591 && set
6592 && SET_SRC (set) == rl->reg_rtx)
6594 int src = REGNO (SET_SRC (set));
6596 reload_spill_index[j] = src;
6597 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, src);
6598 if (find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, src))
6599 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src);
6601 if (REGNO (rl->reg_rtx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6603 int s = rl->secondary_out_reload;
6604 set = single_set (p);
6605 /* If this reload copies only to the secondary reload
6606 register, the secondary reload does the actual
6607 store. */
6608 if (s >= 0 && set == NULL_RTX)
6609 /* We can't tell what function the secondary reload
6610 has and where the actual store to the pseudo is
6611 made; leave new_spill_reg_store alone. */
6613 else if (s >= 0
6614 && SET_SRC (set) == rl->reg_rtx
6615 && SET_DEST (set) == rld[s].reg_rtx)
6617 /* Usually the next instruction will be the
6618 secondary reload insn; if we can confirm
6619 that it is, setting new_spill_reg_store to
6620 that insn will allow an extra optimization. */
6621 rtx s_reg = rld[s].reg_rtx;
6622 rtx next = NEXT_INSN (p);
6623 rld[s].out = rl->out;
6624 rld[s].out_reg = rl->out_reg;
6625 set = single_set (next);
6626 if (set && SET_SRC (set) == s_reg
6627 && ! new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (s_reg)])
6629 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
6630 REGNO (s_reg));
6631 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (s_reg)] = next;
6634 else
6635 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (rl->reg_rtx)] = p;
6640 if (rl->when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER)
6642 emit_insns (other_output_reload_insns[rl->opnum]);
6643 other_output_reload_insns[rl->opnum] = get_insns ();
6645 else
6646 output_reload_insns[rl->opnum] = get_insns ();
6648 end_sequence ();
6651 /* Do input reloading for reload RL, which is for the insn described by CHAIN
6652 and has the number J. */
6653 static void
6654 do_input_reload (chain, rl, j)
6655 struct insn_chain *chain;
6656 struct reload *rl;
6657 int j;
6659 int expect_occurrences = 1;
6660 rtx insn = chain->insn;
6661 rtx old = (rl->in && GET_CODE (rl->in) == MEM
6662 ? rl->in_reg : rl->in);
6664 if (old != 0
6665 /* AUTO_INC reloads need to be handled even if inherited. We got an
6666 AUTO_INC reload if reload_out is set but reload_out_reg isn't. */
6667 && (! reload_inherited[j] || (rl->out && ! rl->out_reg))
6668 && ! rtx_equal_p (rl->reg_rtx, old)
6669 && rl->reg_rtx != 0)
6670 emit_input_reload_insns (chain, rld + j, old, j);
6672 /* When inheriting a wider reload, we have a MEM in rl->in,
6673 e.g. inheriting a SImode output reload for
6674 (mem:HI (plus:SI (reg:SI 14 fp) (const_int 10))) */
6675 if (optimize && reload_inherited[j] && rl->in
6676 && GET_CODE (rl->in) == MEM
6677 && GET_CODE (rl->in_reg) == MEM
6678 && reload_spill_index[j] >= 0
6679 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, reload_spill_index[j]))
6681 expect_occurrences
6682 = count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), rl->in, 0) == 1 ? 0 : -1;
6683 rl->in = regno_reg_rtx[reg_reloaded_contents[reload_spill_index[j]]];
6686 /* If we are reloading a register that was recently stored in with an
6687 output-reload, see if we can prove there was
6688 actually no need to store the old value in it. */
6690 if (optimize
6691 && (reload_inherited[j] || reload_override_in[j])
6692 && rl->reg_rtx
6693 && GET_CODE (rl->reg_rtx) == REG
6694 && spill_reg_store[REGNO (rl->reg_rtx)] != 0
6695 #if 0
6696 /* There doesn't seem to be any reason to restrict this to pseudos
6697 and doing so loses in the case where we are copying from a
6698 register of the wrong class. */
6699 && (REGNO (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (rl->reg_rtx)])
6700 >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6701 #endif
6702 /* The insn might have already some references to stackslots
6703 replaced by MEMs, while reload_out_reg still names the
6704 original pseudo. */
6705 && (dead_or_set_p (insn,
6706 spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (rl->reg_rtx)])
6707 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (rl->reg_rtx)],
6708 rl->out_reg)))
6709 delete_output_reload (insn, j, REGNO (rl->reg_rtx));
6712 /* Do output reloading for reload RL, which is for the insn described by
6713 CHAIN and has the number J.
6714 ??? At some point we need to support handling output reloads of
6715 JUMP_INSNs or insns that set cc0. */
6716 static void
6717 do_output_reload (chain, rl, j)
6718 struct insn_chain *chain;
6719 struct reload *rl;
6720 int j;
6722 rtx note, old;
6723 rtx insn = chain->insn;
6724 /* If this is an output reload that stores something that is
6725 not loaded in this same reload, see if we can eliminate a previous
6726 store. */
6727 rtx pseudo = rl->out_reg;
6729 if (pseudo
6730 && GET_CODE (pseudo) == REG
6731 && ! rtx_equal_p (rl->in_reg, pseudo)
6732 && REGNO (pseudo) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6733 && reg_last_reload_reg[REGNO (pseudo)])
6735 int pseudo_no = REGNO (pseudo);
6736 int last_regno = REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[pseudo_no]);
6738 /* We don't need to test full validity of last_regno for
6739 inherit here; we only want to know if the store actually
6740 matches the pseudo. */
6741 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, last_regno)
6742 && reg_reloaded_contents[last_regno] == pseudo_no
6743 && spill_reg_store[last_regno]
6744 && rtx_equal_p (pseudo, spill_reg_stored_to[last_regno]))
6745 delete_output_reload (insn, j, last_regno);
6748 old = rl->out_reg;
6749 if (old == 0
6750 || rl->reg_rtx == old
6751 || rl->reg_rtx == 0)
6752 return;
6754 /* An output operand that dies right away does need a reload,
6755 but need not be copied from it. Show the new location in the
6756 REG_UNUSED note. */
6757 if ((GET_CODE (old) == REG || GET_CODE (old) == SCRATCH)
6758 && (note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_UNUSED, old)) != 0)
6760 XEXP (note, 0) = rl->reg_rtx;
6761 return;
6763 /* Likewise for a SUBREG of an operand that dies. */
6764 else if (GET_CODE (old) == SUBREG
6765 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (old)) == REG
6766 && 0 != (note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_UNUSED,
6767 SUBREG_REG (old))))
6769 XEXP (note, 0) = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (old),
6770 rl->reg_rtx);
6771 return;
6773 else if (GET_CODE (old) == SCRATCH)
6774 /* If we aren't optimizing, there won't be a REG_UNUSED note,
6775 but we don't want to make an output reload. */
6776 return;
6778 /* If is a JUMP_INSN, we can't support output reloads yet. */
6779 if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN)
6780 abort ();
6782 emit_output_reload_insns (chain, rld + j, j);
6785 /* Output insns to reload values in and out of the chosen reload regs. */
6787 static void
6788 emit_reload_insns (chain)
6789 struct insn_chain *chain;
6791 rtx insn = chain->insn;
6793 register int j;
6794 rtx following_insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
6795 rtx before_insn = PREV_INSN (insn);
6797 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_died);
6799 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
6800 input_reload_insns[j] = input_address_reload_insns[j]
6801 = inpaddr_address_reload_insns[j]
6802 = output_reload_insns[j] = output_address_reload_insns[j]
6803 = outaddr_address_reload_insns[j]
6804 = other_output_reload_insns[j] = 0;
6805 other_input_address_reload_insns = 0;
6806 other_input_reload_insns = 0;
6807 operand_reload_insns = 0;
6808 other_operand_reload_insns = 0;
6810 /* Dump reloads into the dump file. */
6811 if (rtl_dump_file)
6813 fprintf (rtl_dump_file, "\nReloads for insn # %d\n", INSN_UID (insn));
6814 debug_reload_to_stream (rtl_dump_file);
6817 /* Now output the instructions to copy the data into and out of the
6818 reload registers. Do these in the order that the reloads were reported,
6819 since reloads of base and index registers precede reloads of operands
6820 and the operands may need the base and index registers reloaded. */
6822 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6824 if (rld[j].reg_rtx
6825 && REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6826 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx)] = 0;
6828 do_input_reload (chain, rld + j, j);
6829 do_output_reload (chain, rld + j, j);
6832 /* Now write all the insns we made for reloads in the order expected by
6833 the allocation functions. Prior to the insn being reloaded, we write
6834 the following reloads:
6836 RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reloads for input addresses.
6838 RELOAD_OTHER reloads.
6840 For each operand, any RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reloads followed
6841 by any RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS reloads followed by the
6842 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reload for the operand.
6844 RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDRS reloads.
6846 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads.
6848 After the insn being reloaded, we write the following:
6850 For each operand, any RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reloads followed
6851 by any RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload followed by the
6852 RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reload, followed by any RELOAD_OTHER output
6853 reloads for the operand. The RELOAD_OTHER output reloads are
6854 output in descending order by reload number. */
6856 emit_insns_before (other_input_address_reload_insns, insn);
6857 emit_insns_before (other_input_reload_insns, insn);
6859 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
6861 emit_insns_before (inpaddr_address_reload_insns[j], insn);
6862 emit_insns_before (input_address_reload_insns[j], insn);
6863 emit_insns_before (input_reload_insns[j], insn);
6866 emit_insns_before (other_operand_reload_insns, insn);
6867 emit_insns_before (operand_reload_insns, insn);
6869 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
6871 emit_insns_before (outaddr_address_reload_insns[j], following_insn);
6872 emit_insns_before (output_address_reload_insns[j], following_insn);
6873 emit_insns_before (output_reload_insns[j], following_insn);
6874 emit_insns_before (other_output_reload_insns[j], following_insn);
6877 /* Keep basic block info up to date. */
6878 if (n_basic_blocks)
6880 if (BLOCK_HEAD (chain->block) == insn)
6881 BLOCK_HEAD (chain->block) = NEXT_INSN (before_insn);
6882 if (BLOCK_END (chain->block) == insn)
6883 BLOCK_END (chain->block) = PREV_INSN (following_insn);
6886 /* For all the spill regs newly reloaded in this instruction,
6887 record what they were reloaded from, so subsequent instructions
6888 can inherit the reloads.
6890 Update spill_reg_store for the reloads of this insn.
6891 Copy the elements that were updated in the loop above. */
6893 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6895 register int r = reload_order[j];
6896 register int i = reload_spill_index[r];
6898 /* If this is a non-inherited input reload from a pseudo, we must
6899 clear any memory of a previous store to the same pseudo. Only do
6900 something if there will not be an output reload for the pseudo
6901 being reloaded. */
6902 if (rld[r].in_reg != 0
6903 && ! (reload_inherited[r] || reload_override_in[r]))
6905 rtx reg = rld[r].in_reg;
6907 if (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG)
6908 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
6910 if (GET_CODE (reg) == REG
6911 && REGNO (reg) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6912 && ! reg_has_output_reload[REGNO (reg)])
6914 int nregno = REGNO (reg);
6916 if (reg_last_reload_reg[nregno])
6918 int last_regno = REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[nregno]);
6920 if (reg_reloaded_contents[last_regno] == nregno)
6921 spill_reg_store[last_regno] = 0;
6926 /* I is nonneg if this reload used a register.
6927 If rld[r].reg_rtx is 0, this is an optional reload
6928 that we opted to ignore. */
6930 if (i >= 0 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0)
6932 int nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i, GET_MODE (rld[r].reg_rtx));
6933 int k;
6934 int part_reaches_end = 0;
6935 int all_reaches_end = 1;
6937 /* For a multi register reload, we need to check if all or part
6938 of the value lives to the end. */
6939 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
6941 if (reload_reg_reaches_end_p (i + k, rld[r].opnum,
6942 rld[r].when_needed))
6943 part_reaches_end = 1;
6944 else
6945 all_reaches_end = 0;
6948 /* Ignore reloads that don't reach the end of the insn in
6949 entirety. */
6950 if (all_reaches_end)
6952 /* First, clear out memory of what used to be in this spill reg.
6953 If consecutive registers are used, clear them all. */
6955 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
6956 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
6958 /* Maybe the spill reg contains a copy of reload_out. */
6959 if (rld[r].out != 0
6960 && (GET_CODE (rld[r].out) == REG
6961 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
6962 || ! rld[r].out_reg
6963 #endif
6964 || GET_CODE (rld[r].out_reg) == REG))
6966 rtx out = (GET_CODE (rld[r].out) == REG
6967 ? rld[r].out
6968 : rld[r].out_reg
6969 ? rld[r].out_reg
6970 /* AUTO_INC */ : XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
6971 register int nregno = REGNO (out);
6972 int nnr = (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER ? 1
6973 : HARD_REGNO_NREGS (nregno,
6974 GET_MODE (rld[r].reg_rtx)));
6976 spill_reg_store[i] = new_spill_reg_store[i];
6977 spill_reg_stored_to[i] = out;
6978 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno] = rld[r].reg_rtx;
6980 /* If NREGNO is a hard register, it may occupy more than
6981 one register. If it does, say what is in the
6982 rest of the registers assuming that both registers
6983 agree on how many words the object takes. If not,
6984 invalidate the subsequent registers. */
6986 if (nregno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6987 for (k = 1; k < nnr; k++)
6988 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno + k]
6989 = (nr == nnr
6990 ? gen_rtx_REG (reg_raw_mode[REGNO (rld[r].reg_rtx) + k],
6991 REGNO (rld[r].reg_rtx) + k)
6992 : 0);
6994 /* Now do the inverse operation. */
6995 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
6997 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, i + k);
6998 reg_reloaded_contents[i + k]
6999 = (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER || nr != nnr
7000 ? nregno
7001 : nregno + k);
7002 reg_reloaded_insn[i + k] = insn;
7003 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
7007 /* Maybe the spill reg contains a copy of reload_in. Only do
7008 something if there will not be an output reload for
7009 the register being reloaded. */
7010 else if (rld[r].out_reg == 0
7011 && rld[r].in != 0
7012 && ((GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == REG
7013 && REGNO (rld[r].in) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7014 && ! reg_has_output_reload[REGNO (rld[r].in)])
7015 || (GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == REG
7016 && ! reg_has_output_reload[REGNO (rld[r].in_reg)]))
7017 && ! reg_set_p (rld[r].reg_rtx, PATTERN (insn)))
7019 register int nregno;
7020 int nnr;
7022 if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == REG
7023 && REGNO (rld[r].in) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7024 nregno = REGNO (rld[r].in);
7025 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == REG)
7026 nregno = REGNO (rld[r].in_reg);
7027 else
7028 nregno = REGNO (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
7030 nnr = (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER ? 1
7031 : HARD_REGNO_NREGS (nregno,
7032 GET_MODE (rld[r].reg_rtx)));
7034 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno] = rld[r].reg_rtx;
7036 if (nregno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7037 for (k = 1; k < nnr; k++)
7038 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno + k]
7039 = (nr == nnr
7040 ? gen_rtx_REG (reg_raw_mode[REGNO (rld[r].reg_rtx) + k],
7041 REGNO (rld[r].reg_rtx) + k)
7042 : 0);
7044 /* Unless we inherited this reload, show we haven't
7045 recently done a store.
7046 Previous stores of inherited auto_inc expressions
7047 also have to be discarded. */
7048 if (! reload_inherited[r]
7049 || (rld[r].out && ! rld[r].out_reg))
7050 spill_reg_store[i] = 0;
7052 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
7054 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, i + k);
7055 reg_reloaded_contents[i + k]
7056 = (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER || nr != nnr
7057 ? nregno
7058 : nregno + k);
7059 reg_reloaded_insn[i + k] = insn;
7060 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
7065 /* However, if part of the reload reaches the end, then we must
7066 invalidate the old info for the part that survives to the end. */
7067 else if (part_reaches_end)
7069 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
7070 if (reload_reg_reaches_end_p (i + k,
7071 rld[r].opnum,
7072 rld[r].when_needed))
7073 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
7077 /* The following if-statement was #if 0'd in 1.34 (or before...).
7078 It's reenabled in 1.35 because supposedly nothing else
7079 deals with this problem. */
7081 /* If a register gets output-reloaded from a non-spill register,
7082 that invalidates any previous reloaded copy of it.
7083 But forget_old_reloads_1 won't get to see it, because
7084 it thinks only about the original insn. So invalidate it here. */
7085 if (i < 0 && rld[r].out != 0
7086 && (GET_CODE (rld[r].out) == REG
7087 || (GET_CODE (rld[r].out) == MEM
7088 && GET_CODE (rld[r].out_reg) == REG)))
7090 rtx out = (GET_CODE (rld[r].out) == REG
7091 ? rld[r].out : rld[r].out_reg);
7092 register int nregno = REGNO (out);
7093 if (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7095 rtx src_reg, store_insn = NULL_RTX;
7097 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno] = 0;
7099 /* If we can find a hard register that is stored, record
7100 the storing insn so that we may delete this insn with
7101 delete_output_reload. */
7102 src_reg = rld[r].reg_rtx;
7104 /* If this is an optional reload, try to find the source reg
7105 from an input reload. */
7106 if (! src_reg)
7108 rtx set = single_set (insn);
7109 if (set && SET_DEST (set) == rld[r].out)
7111 int k;
7113 src_reg = SET_SRC (set);
7114 store_insn = insn;
7115 for (k = 0; k < n_reloads; k++)
7117 if (rld[k].in == src_reg)
7119 src_reg = rld[k].reg_rtx;
7120 break;
7125 else
7126 store_insn = new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (src_reg)];
7127 if (src_reg && GET_CODE (src_reg) == REG
7128 && REGNO (src_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7130 int src_regno = REGNO (src_reg);
7131 int nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (src_regno, rld[r].mode);
7132 /* The place where to find a death note varies with
7133 PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P . The condition is not
7134 necessarily checked exactly in the code that moves
7135 notes, so just check both locations. */
7136 rtx note = find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, src_regno);
7137 if (! note)
7138 note = find_regno_note (store_insn, REG_DEAD, src_regno);
7139 while (nr-- > 0)
7141 spill_reg_store[src_regno + nr] = store_insn;
7142 spill_reg_stored_to[src_regno + nr] = out;
7143 reg_reloaded_contents[src_regno + nr] = nregno;
7144 reg_reloaded_insn[src_regno + nr] = store_insn;
7145 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, src_regno + nr);
7146 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, src_regno + nr);
7147 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, src_regno + nr);
7148 if (note)
7149 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src_regno);
7150 else
7151 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src_regno);
7153 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno] = src_reg;
7156 else
7158 int num_regs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (nregno, GET_MODE (rld[r].out));
7160 while (num_regs-- > 0)
7161 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno + num_regs] = 0;
7165 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_dead, reg_reloaded_died);
7168 /* Emit code to perform a reload from IN (which may be a reload register) to
7169 OUT (which may also be a reload register). IN or OUT is from operand
7170 OPNUM with reload type TYPE.
7172 Returns first insn emitted. */
7175 gen_reload (out, in, opnum, type)
7176 rtx out;
7177 rtx in;
7178 int opnum;
7179 enum reload_type type;
7181 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
7182 rtx tem;
7184 /* If IN is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it and try to put the
7185 opposite SUBREG on OUT. Likewise for a paradoxical SUBREG on OUT. */
7186 if (GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG
7187 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (in))
7188 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in))))
7189 && (tem = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in)), out)) != 0)
7190 in = SUBREG_REG (in), out = tem;
7191 else if (GET_CODE (out) == SUBREG
7192 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (out))
7193 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (out))))
7194 && (tem = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (out)), in)) != 0)
7195 out = SUBREG_REG (out), in = tem;
7197 /* How to do this reload can get quite tricky. Normally, we are being
7198 asked to reload a simple operand, such as a MEM, a constant, or a pseudo
7199 register that didn't get a hard register. In that case we can just
7200 call emit_move_insn.
7202 We can also be asked to reload a PLUS that adds a register or a MEM to
7203 another register, constant or MEM. This can occur during frame pointer
7204 elimination and while reloading addresses. This case is handled by
7205 trying to emit a single insn to perform the add. If it is not valid,
7206 we use a two insn sequence.
7208 Finally, we could be called to handle an 'o' constraint by putting
7209 an address into a register. In that case, we first try to do this
7210 with a named pattern of "reload_load_address". If no such pattern
7211 exists, we just emit a SET insn and hope for the best (it will normally
7212 be valid on machines that use 'o').
7214 This entire process is made complex because reload will never
7215 process the insns we generate here and so we must ensure that
7216 they will fit their constraints and also by the fact that parts of
7217 IN might be being reloaded separately and replaced with spill registers.
7218 Because of this, we are, in some sense, just guessing the right approach
7219 here. The one listed above seems to work.
7221 ??? At some point, this whole thing needs to be rethought. */
7223 if (GET_CODE (in) == PLUS
7224 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 0)) == REG
7225 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 0)) == SUBREG
7226 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 0)) == MEM)
7227 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == REG
7228 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == SUBREG
7229 || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (in, 1))
7230 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == MEM))
7232 /* We need to compute the sum of a register or a MEM and another
7233 register, constant, or MEM, and put it into the reload
7234 register. The best possible way of doing this is if the machine
7235 has a three-operand ADD insn that accepts the required operands.
7237 The simplest approach is to try to generate such an insn and see if it
7238 is recognized and matches its constraints. If so, it can be used.
7240 It might be better not to actually emit the insn unless it is valid,
7241 but we need to pass the insn as an operand to `recog' and
7242 `extract_insn' and it is simpler to emit and then delete the insn if
7243 not valid than to dummy things up. */
7245 rtx op0, op1, tem, insn;
7246 int code;
7248 op0 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 0));
7249 op1 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 1));
7251 /* Since constraint checking is strict, commutativity won't be
7252 checked, so we need to do that here to avoid spurious failure
7253 if the add instruction is two-address and the second operand
7254 of the add is the same as the reload reg, which is frequently
7255 the case. If the insn would be A = B + A, rearrange it so
7256 it will be A = A + B as constrain_operands expects. */
7258 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == REG
7259 && REGNO (out) == REGNO (XEXP (in, 1)))
7260 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
7262 if (op0 != XEXP (in, 0) || op1 != XEXP (in, 1))
7263 in = gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (in), op0, op1);
7265 insn = emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
7266 code = recog_memoized (insn);
7268 if (code >= 0)
7270 extract_insn (insn);
7271 /* We want constrain operands to treat this insn strictly in
7272 its validity determination, i.e., the way it would after reload
7273 has completed. */
7274 if (constrain_operands (1))
7275 return insn;
7278 delete_insns_since (last);
7280 /* If that failed, we must use a conservative two-insn sequence.
7282 Use a move to copy one operand into the reload register. Prefer
7283 to reload a constant, MEM or pseudo since the move patterns can
7284 handle an arbitrary operand. If OP1 is not a constant, MEM or
7285 pseudo and OP1 is not a valid operand for an add instruction, then
7286 reload OP1.
7288 After reloading one of the operands into the reload register, add
7289 the reload register to the output register.
7291 If there is another way to do this for a specific machine, a
7292 DEFINE_PEEPHOLE should be specified that recognizes the sequence
7293 we emit below. */
7295 code = (int) add_optab->handlers[(int) GET_MODE (out)].insn_code;
7297 if (CONSTANT_P (op1) || GET_CODE (op1) == MEM || GET_CODE (op1) == SUBREG
7298 || (GET_CODE (op1) == REG
7299 && REGNO (op1) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7300 || (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
7301 && ! ((*insn_data[code].operand[2].predicate)
7302 (op1, insn_data[code].operand[2].mode))))
7303 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
7305 gen_reload (out, op0, opnum, type);
7307 /* If OP0 and OP1 are the same, we can use OUT for OP1.
7308 This fixes a problem on the 32K where the stack pointer cannot
7309 be used as an operand of an add insn. */
7311 if (rtx_equal_p (op0, op1))
7312 op1 = out;
7314 insn = emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (out, op1));
7316 /* If that failed, copy the address register to the reload register.
7317 Then add the constant to the reload register. */
7319 code = recog_memoized (insn);
7321 if (code >= 0)
7323 extract_insn (insn);
7324 /* We want constrain operands to treat this insn strictly in
7325 its validity determination, i.e., the way it would after reload
7326 has completed. */
7327 if (constrain_operands (1))
7329 /* Add a REG_EQUIV note so that find_equiv_reg can find it. */
7330 REG_NOTES (insn)
7331 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV, in, REG_NOTES (insn));
7332 return insn;
7336 delete_insns_since (last);
7338 gen_reload (out, op1, opnum, type);
7339 insn = emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (out, op0));
7340 REG_NOTES (insn) = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV, in, REG_NOTES (insn));
7343 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
7344 /* If we need a memory location to do the move, do it that way. */
7345 else if (GET_CODE (in) == REG && REGNO (in) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7346 && GET_CODE (out) == REG && REGNO (out) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7347 && SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (in)),
7348 REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (out)),
7349 GET_MODE (out)))
7351 /* Get the memory to use and rewrite both registers to its mode. */
7352 rtx loc = get_secondary_mem (in, GET_MODE (out), opnum, type);
7354 if (GET_MODE (loc) != GET_MODE (out))
7355 out = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (loc), REGNO (out));
7357 if (GET_MODE (loc) != GET_MODE (in))
7358 in = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (loc), REGNO (in));
7360 gen_reload (loc, in, opnum, type);
7361 gen_reload (out, loc, opnum, type);
7363 #endif
7365 /* If IN is a simple operand, use gen_move_insn. */
7366 else if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (in)) == 'o' || GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG)
7367 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (out, in));
7369 #ifdef HAVE_reload_load_address
7370 else if (HAVE_reload_load_address)
7371 emit_insn (gen_reload_load_address (out, in));
7372 #endif
7374 /* Otherwise, just write (set OUT IN) and hope for the best. */
7375 else
7376 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
7378 /* Return the first insn emitted.
7379 We can not just return get_last_insn, because there may have
7380 been multiple instructions emitted. Also note that gen_move_insn may
7381 emit more than one insn itself, so we can not assume that there is one
7382 insn emitted per emit_insn_before call. */
7384 return last ? NEXT_INSN (last) : get_insns ();
7387 /* Delete a previously made output-reload
7388 whose result we now believe is not needed.
7389 First we double-check.
7391 INSN is the insn now being processed.
7392 LAST_RELOAD_REG is the hard register number for which we want to delete
7393 the last output reload.
7394 J is the reload-number that originally used REG. The caller has made
7395 certain that reload J doesn't use REG any longer for input. */
7397 static void
7398 delete_output_reload (insn, j, last_reload_reg)
7399 rtx insn;
7400 int j;
7401 int last_reload_reg;
7403 rtx output_reload_insn = spill_reg_store[last_reload_reg];
7404 rtx reg = spill_reg_stored_to[last_reload_reg];
7405 int k;
7406 int n_occurrences;
7407 int n_inherited = 0;
7408 register rtx i1;
7409 rtx substed;
7411 /* Get the raw pseudo-register referred to. */
7413 while (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG)
7414 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
7415 substed = reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (reg)];
7417 /* This is unsafe if the operand occurs more often in the current
7418 insn than it is inherited. */
7419 for (k = n_reloads - 1; k >= 0; k--)
7421 rtx reg2 = rld[k].in;
7422 if (! reg2)
7423 continue;
7424 if (GET_CODE (reg2) == MEM || reload_override_in[k])
7425 reg2 = rld[k].in_reg;
7426 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
7427 if (rld[k].out && ! rld[k].out_reg)
7428 reg2 = XEXP (rld[k].in_reg, 0);
7429 #endif
7430 while (GET_CODE (reg2) == SUBREG)
7431 reg2 = SUBREG_REG (reg2);
7432 if (rtx_equal_p (reg2, reg))
7434 if (reload_inherited[k] || reload_override_in[k] || k == j)
7436 n_inherited++;
7437 reg2 = rld[k].out_reg;
7438 if (! reg2)
7439 continue;
7440 while (GET_CODE (reg2) == SUBREG)
7441 reg2 = XEXP (reg2, 0);
7442 if (rtx_equal_p (reg2, reg))
7443 n_inherited++;
7445 else
7446 return;
7449 n_occurrences = count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), reg, 0);
7450 if (substed)
7451 n_occurrences += count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), substed, 0);
7452 if (n_occurrences > n_inherited)
7453 return;
7455 /* If the pseudo-reg we are reloading is no longer referenced
7456 anywhere between the store into it and here,
7457 and no jumps or labels intervene, then the value can get
7458 here through the reload reg alone.
7459 Otherwise, give up--return. */
7460 for (i1 = NEXT_INSN (output_reload_insn);
7461 i1 != insn; i1 = NEXT_INSN (i1))
7463 if (GET_CODE (i1) == CODE_LABEL || GET_CODE (i1) == JUMP_INSN)
7464 return;
7465 if ((GET_CODE (i1) == INSN || GET_CODE (i1) == CALL_INSN)
7466 && reg_mentioned_p (reg, PATTERN (i1)))
7468 /* If this is USE in front of INSN, we only have to check that
7469 there are no more references than accounted for by inheritance. */
7470 while (GET_CODE (i1) == INSN && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i1)) == USE)
7472 n_occurrences += rtx_equal_p (reg, XEXP (PATTERN (i1), 0)) != 0;
7473 i1 = NEXT_INSN (i1);
7475 if (n_occurrences <= n_inherited && i1 == insn)
7476 break;
7477 return;
7481 /* The caller has already checked that REG dies or is set in INSN.
7482 It has also checked that we are optimizing, and thus some inaccurancies
7483 in the debugging information are acceptable.
7484 So we could just delete output_reload_insn.
7485 But in some cases we can improve the debugging information without
7486 sacrificing optimization - maybe even improving the code:
7487 See if the pseudo reg has been completely replaced
7488 with reload regs. If so, delete the store insn
7489 and forget we had a stack slot for the pseudo. */
7490 if (rld[j].out != rld[j].in
7491 && REG_N_DEATHS (REGNO (reg)) == 1
7492 && REG_N_SETS (REGNO (reg)) == 1
7493 && REG_BASIC_BLOCK (REGNO (reg)) >= 0
7494 && find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, REGNO (reg)))
7496 rtx i2;
7498 /* We know that it was used only between here
7499 and the beginning of the current basic block.
7500 (We also know that the last use before INSN was
7501 the output reload we are thinking of deleting, but never mind that.)
7502 Search that range; see if any ref remains. */
7503 for (i2 = PREV_INSN (insn); i2; i2 = PREV_INSN (i2))
7505 rtx set = single_set (i2);
7507 /* Uses which just store in the pseudo don't count,
7508 since if they are the only uses, they are dead. */
7509 if (set != 0 && SET_DEST (set) == reg)
7510 continue;
7511 if (GET_CODE (i2) == CODE_LABEL
7512 || GET_CODE (i2) == JUMP_INSN)
7513 break;
7514 if ((GET_CODE (i2) == INSN || GET_CODE (i2) == CALL_INSN)
7515 && reg_mentioned_p (reg, PATTERN (i2)))
7517 /* Some other ref remains; just delete the output reload we
7518 know to be dead. */
7519 delete_address_reloads (output_reload_insn, insn);
7520 PUT_CODE (output_reload_insn, NOTE);
7521 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (output_reload_insn) = 0;
7522 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (output_reload_insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
7523 return;
7527 /* Delete the now-dead stores into this pseudo. */
7528 for (i2 = PREV_INSN (insn); i2; i2 = PREV_INSN (i2))
7530 rtx set = single_set (i2);
7532 if (set != 0 && SET_DEST (set) == reg)
7534 delete_address_reloads (i2, insn);
7535 /* This might be a basic block head,
7536 thus don't use delete_insn. */
7537 PUT_CODE (i2, NOTE);
7538 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (i2) = 0;
7539 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (i2) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
7541 if (GET_CODE (i2) == CODE_LABEL
7542 || GET_CODE (i2) == JUMP_INSN)
7543 break;
7546 /* For the debugging info,
7547 say the pseudo lives in this reload reg. */
7548 reg_renumber[REGNO (reg)] = REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx);
7549 alter_reg (REGNO (reg), -1);
7551 delete_address_reloads (output_reload_insn, insn);
7552 PUT_CODE (output_reload_insn, NOTE);
7553 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (output_reload_insn) = 0;
7554 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (output_reload_insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
7558 /* We are going to delete DEAD_INSN. Recursively delete loads of
7559 reload registers used in DEAD_INSN that are not used till CURRENT_INSN.
7560 CURRENT_INSN is being reloaded, so we have to check its reloads too. */
7561 static void
7562 delete_address_reloads (dead_insn, current_insn)
7563 rtx dead_insn, current_insn;
7565 rtx set = single_set (dead_insn);
7566 rtx set2, dst, prev, next;
7567 if (set)
7569 rtx dst = SET_DEST (set);
7570 if (GET_CODE (dst) == MEM)
7571 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XEXP (dst, 0), current_insn);
7573 /* If we deleted the store from a reloaded post_{in,de}c expression,
7574 we can delete the matching adds. */
7575 prev = PREV_INSN (dead_insn);
7576 next = NEXT_INSN (dead_insn);
7577 if (! prev || ! next)
7578 return;
7579 set = single_set (next);
7580 set2 = single_set (prev);
7581 if (! set || ! set2
7582 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) != PLUS || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set2)) != PLUS
7583 || GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1)) != CONST_INT
7584 || GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 1)) != CONST_INT)
7585 return;
7586 dst = SET_DEST (set);
7587 if (! rtx_equal_p (dst, SET_DEST (set2))
7588 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0))
7589 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 0))
7590 || (INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1))
7591 != -INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 1))))
7592 return;
7593 delete_insn (prev);
7594 delete_insn (next);
7597 /* Subfunction of delete_address_reloads: process registers found in X. */
7598 static void
7599 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, x, current_insn)
7600 rtx dead_insn, x, current_insn;
7602 rtx prev, set, dst, i2;
7603 int i, j;
7604 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
7606 if (code != REG)
7608 const char *fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
7609 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
7611 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
7612 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XEXP (x, i), current_insn);
7613 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
7615 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
7616 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XVECEXP (x, i, j),
7617 current_insn);
7620 return;
7623 if (spill_reg_order[REGNO (x)] < 0)
7624 return;
7626 /* Scan backwards for the insn that sets x. This might be a way back due
7627 to inheritance. */
7628 for (prev = PREV_INSN (dead_insn); prev; prev = PREV_INSN (prev))
7630 code = GET_CODE (prev);
7631 if (code == CODE_LABEL || code == JUMP_INSN)
7632 return;
7633 if (GET_RTX_CLASS (code) != 'i')
7634 continue;
7635 if (reg_set_p (x, PATTERN (prev)))
7636 break;
7637 if (reg_referenced_p (x, PATTERN (prev)))
7638 return;
7640 if (! prev || INSN_UID (prev) < reload_first_uid)
7641 return;
7642 /* Check that PREV only sets the reload register. */
7643 set = single_set (prev);
7644 if (! set)
7645 return;
7646 dst = SET_DEST (set);
7647 if (GET_CODE (dst) != REG
7648 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, x))
7649 return;
7650 if (! reg_set_p (dst, PATTERN (dead_insn)))
7652 /* Check if DST was used in a later insn -
7653 it might have been inherited. */
7654 for (i2 = NEXT_INSN (dead_insn); i2; i2 = NEXT_INSN (i2))
7656 if (GET_CODE (i2) == CODE_LABEL)
7657 break;
7658 if (! INSN_P (i2))
7659 continue;
7660 if (reg_referenced_p (dst, PATTERN (i2)))
7662 /* If there is a reference to the register in the current insn,
7663 it might be loaded in a non-inherited reload. If no other
7664 reload uses it, that means the register is set before
7665 referenced. */
7666 if (i2 == current_insn)
7668 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
7669 if ((rld[j].reg_rtx == dst && reload_inherited[j])
7670 || reload_override_in[j] == dst)
7671 return;
7672 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
7673 if (rld[j].in && rld[j].reg_rtx == dst)
7674 break;
7675 if (j >= 0)
7676 break;
7678 return;
7680 if (GET_CODE (i2) == JUMP_INSN)
7681 break;
7682 /* If DST is still live at CURRENT_INSN, check if it is used for
7683 any reload. Note that even if CURRENT_INSN sets DST, we still
7684 have to check the reloads. */
7685 if (i2 == current_insn)
7687 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
7688 if ((rld[j].reg_rtx == dst && reload_inherited[j])
7689 || reload_override_in[j] == dst)
7690 return;
7691 /* ??? We can't finish the loop here, because dst might be
7692 allocated to a pseudo in this block if no reload in this
7693 block needs any of the clsses containing DST - see
7694 spill_hard_reg. There is no easy way to tell this, so we
7695 have to scan till the end of the basic block. */
7697 if (reg_set_p (dst, PATTERN (i2)))
7698 break;
7701 delete_address_reloads_1 (prev, SET_SRC (set), current_insn);
7702 reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (dst)] = -1;
7703 /* Can't use delete_insn here because PREV might be a basic block head. */
7704 PUT_CODE (prev, NOTE);
7705 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (prev) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
7706 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (prev) = 0;
7709 /* Output reload-insns to reload VALUE into RELOADREG.
7710 VALUE is an autoincrement or autodecrement RTX whose operand
7711 is a register or memory location;
7712 so reloading involves incrementing that location.
7713 IN is either identical to VALUE, or some cheaper place to reload from.
7715 INC_AMOUNT is the number to increment or decrement by (always positive).
7716 This cannot be deduced from VALUE.
7718 Return the instruction that stores into RELOADREG. */
7720 static rtx
7721 inc_for_reload (reloadreg, in, value, inc_amount)
7722 rtx reloadreg;
7723 rtx in, value;
7724 int inc_amount;
7726 /* REG or MEM to be copied and incremented. */
7727 rtx incloc = XEXP (value, 0);
7728 /* Nonzero if increment after copying. */
7729 int post = (GET_CODE (value) == POST_DEC || GET_CODE (value) == POST_INC);
7730 rtx last;
7731 rtx inc;
7732 rtx add_insn;
7733 int code;
7734 rtx store;
7735 rtx real_in = in == value ? XEXP (in, 0) : in;
7737 /* No hard register is equivalent to this register after
7738 inc/dec operation. If REG_LAST_RELOAD_REG were non-zero,
7739 we could inc/dec that register as well (maybe even using it for
7740 the source), but I'm not sure it's worth worrying about. */
7741 if (GET_CODE (incloc) == REG)
7742 reg_last_reload_reg[REGNO (incloc)] = 0;
7744 if (GET_CODE (value) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (value) == POST_DEC)
7745 inc_amount = -inc_amount;
7747 inc = GEN_INT (inc_amount);
7749 /* If this is post-increment, first copy the location to the reload reg. */
7750 if (post && real_in != reloadreg)
7751 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, real_in));
7753 if (in == value)
7755 /* See if we can directly increment INCLOC. Use a method similar to
7756 that in gen_reload. */
7758 last = get_last_insn ();
7759 add_insn = emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, incloc,
7760 gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (incloc),
7761 incloc, inc)));
7763 code = recog_memoized (add_insn);
7764 if (code >= 0)
7766 extract_insn (add_insn);
7767 if (constrain_operands (1))
7769 /* If this is a pre-increment and we have incremented the value
7770 where it lives, copy the incremented value to RELOADREG to
7771 be used as an address. */
7773 if (! post)
7774 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, incloc));
7776 return add_insn;
7779 delete_insns_since (last);
7782 /* If couldn't do the increment directly, must increment in RELOADREG.
7783 The way we do this depends on whether this is pre- or post-increment.
7784 For pre-increment, copy INCLOC to the reload register, increment it
7785 there, then save back. */
7787 if (! post)
7789 if (in != reloadreg)
7790 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, real_in));
7791 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
7792 store = emit_insn (gen_move_insn (incloc, reloadreg));
7794 else
7796 /* Postincrement.
7797 Because this might be a jump insn or a compare, and because RELOADREG
7798 may not be available after the insn in an input reload, we must do
7799 the incrementation before the insn being reloaded for.
7801 We have already copied IN to RELOADREG. Increment the copy in
7802 RELOADREG, save that back, then decrement RELOADREG so it has
7803 the original value. */
7805 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
7806 store = emit_insn (gen_move_insn (incloc, reloadreg));
7807 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, GEN_INT (-inc_amount)));
7810 return store;
7813 /* Return 1 if we are certain that the constraint-string STRING allows
7814 the hard register REG. Return 0 if we can't be sure of this. */
7816 static int
7817 constraint_accepts_reg_p (string, reg)
7818 const char *string;
7819 rtx reg;
7821 int value = 0;
7822 int regno = true_regnum (reg);
7823 int c;
7825 /* Initialize for first alternative. */
7826 value = 0;
7827 /* Check that each alternative contains `g' or `r'. */
7828 while (1)
7829 switch (c = *string++)
7831 case 0:
7832 /* If an alternative lacks `g' or `r', we lose. */
7833 return value;
7834 case ',':
7835 /* If an alternative lacks `g' or `r', we lose. */
7836 if (value == 0)
7837 return 0;
7838 /* Initialize for next alternative. */
7839 value = 0;
7840 break;
7841 case 'g':
7842 case 'r':
7843 /* Any general reg wins for this alternative. */
7844 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) GENERAL_REGS], regno))
7845 value = 1;
7846 break;
7847 default:
7848 /* Any reg in specified class wins for this alternative. */
7850 enum reg_class class = REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (c);
7852 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) class], regno))
7853 value = 1;
7858 /* INSN is a no-op; delete it.
7859 If this sets the return value of the function, we must keep a USE around,
7860 in case this is in a different basic block than the final USE. Otherwise,
7861 we could loose important register lifeness information on
7862 SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES machines, where return registers might be used as
7863 spills: subsequent passes assume that spill registers are dead at the end
7864 of a basic block.
7865 VALUE must be the return value in such a case, NULL otherwise. */
7866 static void
7867 reload_cse_delete_noop_set (insn, value)
7868 rtx insn, value;
7870 if (value)
7872 PATTERN (insn) = gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, value);
7873 INSN_CODE (insn) = -1;
7874 REG_NOTES (insn) = NULL_RTX;
7876 else
7878 PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
7879 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
7880 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
7884 /* See whether a single set SET is a noop. */
7885 static int
7886 reload_cse_noop_set_p (set)
7887 rtx set;
7889 return rtx_equal_for_cselib_p (SET_DEST (set), SET_SRC (set));
7892 /* Try to simplify INSN. */
7893 static void
7894 reload_cse_simplify (insn)
7895 rtx insn;
7897 rtx body = PATTERN (insn);
7899 if (GET_CODE (body) == SET)
7901 int count = 0;
7902 if (reload_cse_noop_set_p (body))
7904 rtx value = SET_DEST (body);
7905 if (! REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (SET_DEST (body)))
7906 value = 0;
7907 reload_cse_delete_noop_set (insn, value);
7908 return;
7911 /* It's not a no-op, but we can try to simplify it. */
7912 count += reload_cse_simplify_set (body, insn);
7914 if (count > 0)
7915 apply_change_group ();
7916 else
7917 reload_cse_simplify_operands (insn);
7919 else if (GET_CODE (body) == PARALLEL)
7921 int i;
7922 int count = 0;
7923 rtx value = NULL_RTX;
7925 /* If every action in a PARALLEL is a noop, we can delete
7926 the entire PARALLEL. */
7927 for (i = XVECLEN (body, 0) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
7929 rtx part = XVECEXP (body, 0, i);
7930 if (GET_CODE (part) == SET)
7932 if (! reload_cse_noop_set_p (part))
7933 break;
7934 if (REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (SET_DEST (part)))
7936 if (value)
7937 break;
7938 value = SET_DEST (part);
7941 else if (GET_CODE (part) != CLOBBER)
7942 break;
7945 if (i < 0)
7947 reload_cse_delete_noop_set (insn, value);
7948 /* We're done with this insn. */
7949 return;
7952 /* It's not a no-op, but we can try to simplify it. */
7953 for (i = XVECLEN (body, 0) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
7954 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (body, 0, i)) == SET)
7955 count += reload_cse_simplify_set (XVECEXP (body, 0, i), insn);
7957 if (count > 0)
7958 apply_change_group ();
7959 else
7960 reload_cse_simplify_operands (insn);
7964 /* Do a very simple CSE pass over the hard registers.
7966 This function detects no-op moves where we happened to assign two
7967 different pseudo-registers to the same hard register, and then
7968 copied one to the other. Reload will generate a useless
7969 instruction copying a register to itself.
7971 This function also detects cases where we load a value from memory
7972 into two different registers, and (if memory is more expensive than
7973 registers) changes it to simply copy the first register into the
7974 second register.
7976 Another optimization is performed that scans the operands of each
7977 instruction to see whether the value is already available in a
7978 hard register. It then replaces the operand with the hard register
7979 if possible, much like an optional reload would. */
7981 static void
7982 reload_cse_regs_1 (first)
7983 rtx first;
7985 rtx insn;
7987 cselib_init ();
7988 init_alias_analysis ();
7990 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
7992 if (INSN_P (insn))
7993 reload_cse_simplify (insn);
7995 cselib_process_insn (insn);
7998 /* Clean up. */
7999 end_alias_analysis ();
8000 cselib_finish ();
8003 /* Call cse / combine like post-reload optimization phases.
8004 FIRST is the first instruction. */
8005 void
8006 reload_cse_regs (first)
8007 rtx first;
8009 reload_cse_regs_1 (first);
8010 reload_combine ();
8011 reload_cse_move2add (first);
8012 if (flag_expensive_optimizations)
8013 reload_cse_regs_1 (first);
8016 /* Try to simplify a single SET instruction. SET is the set pattern.
8017 INSN is the instruction it came from.
8018 This function only handles one case: if we set a register to a value
8019 which is not a register, we try to find that value in some other register
8020 and change the set into a register copy. */
8022 static int
8023 reload_cse_simplify_set (set, insn)
8024 rtx set;
8025 rtx insn;
8027 int did_change = 0;
8028 int dreg;
8029 rtx src;
8030 enum reg_class dclass;
8031 int old_cost;
8032 cselib_val *val;
8033 struct elt_loc_list *l;
8035 dreg = true_regnum (SET_DEST (set));
8036 if (dreg < 0)
8037 return 0;
8039 src = SET_SRC (set);
8040 if (side_effects_p (src) || true_regnum (src) >= 0)
8041 return 0;
8043 dclass = REGNO_REG_CLASS (dreg);
8045 /* If memory loads are cheaper than register copies, don't change them. */
8046 if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
8047 old_cost = MEMORY_MOVE_COST (GET_MODE (src), dclass, 1);
8048 else if (CONSTANT_P (src))
8049 old_cost = rtx_cost (src, SET);
8050 else if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
8051 old_cost = REGISTER_MOVE_COST (REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (src)), dclass);
8052 else
8053 /* ??? */
8054 old_cost = rtx_cost (src, SET);
8056 val = cselib_lookup (src, VOIDmode, 0);
8057 if (! val)
8058 return 0;
8059 for (l = val->locs; l; l = l->next)
8061 int this_cost;
8062 if (CONSTANT_P (l->loc) && ! references_value_p (l->loc, 0))
8063 this_cost = rtx_cost (l->loc, SET);
8064 else if (GET_CODE (l->loc) == REG)
8065 this_cost = REGISTER_MOVE_COST (REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (l->loc)),
8066 dclass);
8067 else
8068 continue;
8069 /* If equal costs, prefer registers over anything else. That tends to
8070 lead to smaller instructions on some machines. */
8071 if ((this_cost < old_cost
8072 || (this_cost == old_cost
8073 && GET_CODE (l->loc) == REG
8074 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) != REG))
8075 && validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (set), copy_rtx (l->loc), 1))
8076 old_cost = this_cost, did_change = 1;
8079 return did_change;
8082 /* Try to replace operands in INSN with equivalent values that are already
8083 in registers. This can be viewed as optional reloading.
8085 For each non-register operand in the insn, see if any hard regs are
8086 known to be equivalent to that operand. Record the alternatives which
8087 can accept these hard registers. Among all alternatives, select the
8088 ones which are better or equal to the one currently matching, where
8089 "better" is in terms of '?' and '!' constraints. Among the remaining
8090 alternatives, select the one which replaces most operands with
8091 hard registers. */
8093 static int
8094 reload_cse_simplify_operands (insn)
8095 rtx insn;
8097 int i, j;
8099 /* For each operand, all registers that are equivalent to it. */
8100 HARD_REG_SET equiv_regs[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
8102 const char *constraints[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
8104 /* Vector recording how bad an alternative is. */
8105 int *alternative_reject;
8106 /* Vector recording how many registers can be introduced by choosing
8107 this alternative. */
8108 int *alternative_nregs;
8109 /* Array of vectors recording, for each operand and each alternative,
8110 which hard register to substitute, or -1 if the operand should be
8111 left as it is. */
8112 int *op_alt_regno[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
8113 /* Array of alternatives, sorted in order of decreasing desirability. */
8114 int *alternative_order;
8115 rtx reg = gen_rtx_REG (VOIDmode, -1);
8117 extract_insn (insn);
8119 if (recog_data.n_alternatives == 0 || recog_data.n_operands == 0)
8120 return 0;
8122 /* Figure out which alternative currently matches. */
8123 if (! constrain_operands (1))
8124 fatal_insn_not_found (insn);
8126 alternative_reject = (int *) alloca (recog_data.n_alternatives * sizeof (int));
8127 alternative_nregs = (int *) alloca (recog_data.n_alternatives * sizeof (int));
8128 alternative_order = (int *) alloca (recog_data.n_alternatives * sizeof (int));
8129 memset ((char *)alternative_reject, 0, recog_data.n_alternatives * sizeof (int));
8130 memset ((char *)alternative_nregs, 0, recog_data.n_alternatives * sizeof (int));
8132 /* For each operand, find out which regs are equivalent. */
8133 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
8135 cselib_val *v;
8136 struct elt_loc_list *l;
8138 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (equiv_regs[i]);
8140 /* cselib blows up on CODE_LABELs. Trying to fix that doesn't seem
8141 right, so avoid the problem here. */
8142 if (GET_CODE (recog_data.operand[i]) == CODE_LABEL)
8143 continue;
8145 v = cselib_lookup (recog_data.operand[i], recog_data.operand_mode[i], 0);
8146 if (! v)
8147 continue;
8149 for (l = v->locs; l; l = l->next)
8150 if (GET_CODE (l->loc) == REG)
8151 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (equiv_regs[i], REGNO (l->loc));
8154 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
8156 enum machine_mode mode;
8157 int regno;
8158 const char *p;
8160 op_alt_regno[i] = (int *) alloca (recog_data.n_alternatives * sizeof (int));
8161 for (j = 0; j < recog_data.n_alternatives; j++)
8162 op_alt_regno[i][j] = -1;
8164 p = constraints[i] = recog_data.constraints[i];
8165 mode = recog_data.operand_mode[i];
8167 /* Add the reject values for each alternative given by the constraints
8168 for this operand. */
8169 j = 0;
8170 while (*p != '\0')
8172 char c = *p++;
8173 if (c == ',')
8174 j++;
8175 else if (c == '?')
8176 alternative_reject[j] += 3;
8177 else if (c == '!')
8178 alternative_reject[j] += 300;
8181 /* We won't change operands which are already registers. We
8182 also don't want to modify output operands. */
8183 regno = true_regnum (recog_data.operand[i]);
8184 if (regno >= 0
8185 || constraints[i][0] == '='
8186 || constraints[i][0] == '+')
8187 continue;
8189 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; regno++)
8191 int class = (int) NO_REGS;
8193 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (equiv_regs[i], regno))
8194 continue;
8196 REGNO (reg) = regno;
8197 PUT_MODE (reg, mode);
8199 /* We found a register equal to this operand. Now look for all
8200 alternatives that can accept this register and have not been
8201 assigned a register they can use yet. */
8202 j = 0;
8203 p = constraints[i];
8204 for (;;)
8206 char c = *p++;
8208 switch (c)
8210 case '=': case '+': case '?':
8211 case '#': case '&': case '!':
8212 case '*': case '%':
8213 case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4':
8214 case '5': case '6': case '7': case '8': case '9':
8215 case 'm': case '<': case '>': case 'V': case 'o':
8216 case 'E': case 'F': case 'G': case 'H':
8217 case 's': case 'i': case 'n':
8218 case 'I': case 'J': case 'K': case 'L':
8219 case 'M': case 'N': case 'O': case 'P':
8220 case 'p': case 'X':
8221 /* These don't say anything we care about. */
8222 break;
8224 case 'g': case 'r':
8225 class = reg_class_subunion[(int) class][(int) GENERAL_REGS];
8226 break;
8228 default:
8229 class
8230 = reg_class_subunion[(int) class][(int) REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER ((unsigned char)c)];
8231 break;
8233 case ',': case '\0':
8234 /* See if REGNO fits this alternative, and set it up as the
8235 replacement register if we don't have one for this
8236 alternative yet and the operand being replaced is not
8237 a cheap CONST_INT. */
8238 if (op_alt_regno[i][j] == -1
8239 && reg_fits_class_p (reg, class, 0, mode)
8240 && (GET_CODE (recog_data.operand[i]) != CONST_INT
8241 || (rtx_cost (recog_data.operand[i], SET)
8242 > rtx_cost (reg, SET))))
8244 alternative_nregs[j]++;
8245 op_alt_regno[i][j] = regno;
8247 j++;
8248 break;
8251 if (c == '\0')
8252 break;
8257 /* Record all alternatives which are better or equal to the currently
8258 matching one in the alternative_order array. */
8259 for (i = j = 0; i < recog_data.n_alternatives; i++)
8260 if (alternative_reject[i] <= alternative_reject[which_alternative])
8261 alternative_order[j++] = i;
8262 recog_data.n_alternatives = j;
8264 /* Sort it. Given a small number of alternatives, a dumb algorithm
8265 won't hurt too much. */
8266 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_alternatives - 1; i++)
8268 int best = i;
8269 int best_reject = alternative_reject[alternative_order[i]];
8270 int best_nregs = alternative_nregs[alternative_order[i]];
8271 int tmp;
8273 for (j = i + 1; j < recog_data.n_alternatives; j++)
8275 int this_reject = alternative_reject[alternative_order[j]];
8276 int this_nregs = alternative_nregs[alternative_order[j]];
8278 if (this_reject < best_reject
8279 || (this_reject == best_reject && this_nregs < best_nregs))
8281 best = j;
8282 best_reject = this_reject;
8283 best_nregs = this_nregs;
8287 tmp = alternative_order[best];
8288 alternative_order[best] = alternative_order[i];
8289 alternative_order[i] = tmp;
8292 /* Substitute the operands as determined by op_alt_regno for the best
8293 alternative. */
8294 j = alternative_order[0];
8296 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
8298 enum machine_mode mode = recog_data.operand_mode[i];
8299 if (op_alt_regno[i][j] == -1)
8300 continue;
8302 validate_change (insn, recog_data.operand_loc[i],
8303 gen_rtx_REG (mode, op_alt_regno[i][j]), 1);
8306 for (i = recog_data.n_dups - 1; i >= 0; i--)
8308 int op = recog_data.dup_num[i];
8309 enum machine_mode mode = recog_data.operand_mode[op];
8311 if (op_alt_regno[op][j] == -1)
8312 continue;
8314 validate_change (insn, recog_data.dup_loc[i],
8315 gen_rtx_REG (mode, op_alt_regno[op][j]), 1);
8318 return apply_change_group ();
8321 /* If reload couldn't use reg+reg+offset addressing, try to use reg+reg
8322 addressing now.
8323 This code might also be useful when reload gave up on reg+reg addresssing
8324 because of clashes between the return register and INDEX_REG_CLASS. */
8326 /* The maximum number of uses of a register we can keep track of to
8327 replace them with reg+reg addressing. */
8328 #define RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES 6
8330 /* INSN is the insn where a register has ben used, and USEP points to the
8331 location of the register within the rtl. */
8332 struct reg_use { rtx insn, *usep; };
8334 /* If the register is used in some unknown fashion, USE_INDEX is negative.
8335 If it is dead, USE_INDEX is RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES, and STORE_RUID
8336 indicates where it becomes live again.
8337 Otherwise, USE_INDEX is the index of the last encountered use of the
8338 register (which is first among these we have seen since we scan backwards),
8339 OFFSET contains the constant offset that is added to the register in
8340 all encountered uses, and USE_RUID indicates the first encountered, i.e.
8341 last, of these uses.
8342 STORE_RUID is always meaningful if we only want to use a value in a
8343 register in a different place: it denotes the next insn in the insn
8344 stream (i.e. the last ecountered) that sets or clobbers the register. */
8345 static struct
8347 struct reg_use reg_use[RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES];
8348 int use_index;
8349 rtx offset;
8350 int store_ruid;
8351 int use_ruid;
8352 } reg_state[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
8354 /* Reverse linear uid. This is increased in reload_combine while scanning
8355 the instructions from last to first. It is used to set last_label_ruid
8356 and the store_ruid / use_ruid fields in reg_state. */
8357 static int reload_combine_ruid;
8359 #define LABEL_LIVE(LABEL) \
8360 (label_live[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (LABEL) - min_labelno])
8362 static void
8363 reload_combine ()
8365 rtx insn, set;
8366 int first_index_reg = 1, last_index_reg = 0;
8367 int i;
8368 unsigned int r;
8369 int last_label_ruid;
8370 int min_labelno, n_labels;
8371 HARD_REG_SET ever_live_at_start, *label_live;
8373 /* If reg+reg can be used in offsetable memory adresses, the main chunk of
8374 reload has already used it where appropriate, so there is no use in
8375 trying to generate it now. */
8376 if (double_reg_address_ok && INDEX_REG_CLASS != NO_REGS)
8377 return;
8379 /* To avoid wasting too much time later searching for an index register,
8380 determine the minimum and maximum index register numbers. */
8381 for (r = 0; r < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; r++)
8382 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[INDEX_REG_CLASS], r))
8384 if (! first_index_reg)
8385 first_index_reg = r;
8387 last_index_reg = r;
8390 /* If no index register is available, we can quit now. */
8391 if (first_index_reg > last_index_reg)
8392 return;
8394 /* Set up LABEL_LIVE and EVER_LIVE_AT_START. The register lifetime
8395 information is a bit fuzzy immediately after reload, but it's
8396 still good enough to determine which registers are live at a jump
8397 destination. */
8398 min_labelno = get_first_label_num ();
8399 n_labels = max_label_num () - min_labelno;
8400 label_live = (HARD_REG_SET *) xmalloc (n_labels * sizeof (HARD_REG_SET));
8401 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (ever_live_at_start);
8403 for (i = n_basic_blocks - 1; i >= 0; i--)
8405 insn = BLOCK_HEAD (i);
8406 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL)
8408 HARD_REG_SET live;
8410 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (live,
8411 BASIC_BLOCK (i)->global_live_at_start);
8412 compute_use_by_pseudos (&live,
8413 BASIC_BLOCK (i)->global_live_at_start);
8414 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (LABEL_LIVE (insn), live);
8415 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (ever_live_at_start, live);
8419 /* Initialize last_label_ruid, reload_combine_ruid and reg_state. */
8420 last_label_ruid = reload_combine_ruid = 0;
8421 for (r = 0; r < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; r++)
8423 reg_state[r].store_ruid = reload_combine_ruid;
8424 if (fixed_regs[r])
8425 reg_state[r].use_index = -1;
8426 else
8427 reg_state[r].use_index = RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES;
8430 for (insn = get_last_insn (); insn; insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
8432 rtx note;
8434 /* We cannot do our optimization across labels. Invalidating all the use
8435 information we have would be costly, so we just note where the label
8436 is and then later disable any optimization that would cross it. */
8437 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL)
8438 last_label_ruid = reload_combine_ruid;
8439 else if (GET_CODE (insn) == BARRIER)
8440 for (r = 0; r < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; r++)
8441 if (! fixed_regs[r])
8442 reg_state[r].use_index = RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES;
8444 if (! INSN_P (insn))
8445 continue;
8447 reload_combine_ruid++;
8449 /* Look for (set (REGX) (CONST_INT))
8450 (set (REGX) (PLUS (REGX) (REGY)))
8452 ... (MEM (REGX)) ...
8453 and convert it to
8454 (set (REGZ) (CONST_INT))
8456 ... (MEM (PLUS (REGZ) (REGY)))... .
8458 First, check that we have (set (REGX) (PLUS (REGX) (REGY)))
8459 and that we know all uses of REGX before it dies. */
8460 set = single_set (insn);
8461 if (set != NULL_RTX
8462 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == REG
8463 && (HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO (SET_DEST (set)),
8464 GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)))
8465 == 1)
8466 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == PLUS
8467 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1)) == REG
8468 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0), SET_DEST (set))
8469 && last_label_ruid < reg_state[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))].use_ruid)
8471 rtx reg = SET_DEST (set);
8472 rtx plus = SET_SRC (set);
8473 rtx base = XEXP (plus, 1);
8474 rtx prev = prev_nonnote_insn (insn);
8475 rtx prev_set = prev ? single_set (prev) : NULL_RTX;
8476 unsigned int regno = REGNO (reg);
8477 rtx const_reg = NULL_RTX;
8478 rtx reg_sum = NULL_RTX;
8480 /* Now, we need an index register.
8481 We'll set index_reg to this index register, const_reg to the
8482 register that is to be loaded with the constant
8483 (denoted as REGZ in the substitution illustration above),
8484 and reg_sum to the register-register that we want to use to
8485 substitute uses of REG (typically in MEMs) with.
8486 First check REG and BASE for being index registers;
8487 we can use them even if they are not dead. */
8488 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[INDEX_REG_CLASS], regno)
8489 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[INDEX_REG_CLASS],
8490 REGNO (base)))
8492 const_reg = reg;
8493 reg_sum = plus;
8495 else
8497 /* Otherwise, look for a free index register. Since we have
8498 checked above that neiter REG nor BASE are index registers,
8499 if we find anything at all, it will be different from these
8500 two registers. */
8501 for (i = first_index_reg; i <= last_index_reg; i++)
8503 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[INDEX_REG_CLASS],
8505 && reg_state[i].use_index == RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES
8506 && reg_state[i].store_ruid <= reg_state[regno].use_ruid
8507 && HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i, GET_MODE (reg)) == 1)
8509 rtx index_reg = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (reg), i);
8511 const_reg = index_reg;
8512 reg_sum = gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (reg), index_reg, base);
8513 break;
8518 /* Check that PREV_SET is indeed (set (REGX) (CONST_INT)) and that
8519 (REGY), i.e. BASE, is not clobbered before the last use we'll
8520 create. */
8521 if (prev_set != 0
8522 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (prev_set)) == CONST_INT
8523 && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (prev_set), reg)
8524 && reg_state[regno].use_index >= 0
8525 && (reg_state[REGNO (base)].store_ruid
8526 <= reg_state[regno].use_ruid)
8527 && reg_sum != 0)
8529 int i;
8531 /* Change destination register and, if necessary, the
8532 constant value in PREV, the constant loading instruction. */
8533 validate_change (prev, &SET_DEST (prev_set), const_reg, 1);
8534 if (reg_state[regno].offset != const0_rtx)
8535 validate_change (prev,
8536 &SET_SRC (prev_set),
8537 GEN_INT (INTVAL (SET_SRC (prev_set))
8538 + INTVAL (reg_state[regno].offset)),
8541 /* Now for every use of REG that we have recorded, replace REG
8542 with REG_SUM. */
8543 for (i = reg_state[regno].use_index;
8544 i < RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES; i++)
8545 validate_change (reg_state[regno].reg_use[i].insn,
8546 reg_state[regno].reg_use[i].usep,
8547 reg_sum, 1);
8549 if (apply_change_group ())
8551 rtx *np;
8553 /* Delete the reg-reg addition. */
8554 PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
8555 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
8556 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
8558 if (reg_state[regno].offset != const0_rtx)
8559 /* Previous REG_EQUIV / REG_EQUAL notes for PREV
8560 are now invalid. */
8561 for (np = &REG_NOTES (prev); *np;)
8563 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (*np) == REG_EQUAL
8564 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*np) == REG_EQUIV)
8565 *np = XEXP (*np, 1);
8566 else
8567 np = &XEXP (*np, 1);
8570 reg_state[regno].use_index = RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES;
8571 reg_state[REGNO (const_reg)].store_ruid
8572 = reload_combine_ruid;
8573 continue;
8578 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), reload_combine_note_store, NULL);
8580 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
8582 rtx link;
8584 for (r = 0; r < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; r++)
8585 if (call_used_regs[r])
8587 reg_state[r].use_index = RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES;
8588 reg_state[r].store_ruid = reload_combine_ruid;
8591 for (link = CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn); link;
8592 link = XEXP (link, 1))
8593 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (link, 0), 0)) == REG)
8595 unsigned int regno = REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (link, 0), 0));
8597 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (link, 0)) == CLOBBER)
8599 reg_state[regno].use_index = RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES;
8600 reg_state[regno].store_ruid = reload_combine_ruid;
8602 else
8603 reg_state[regno].use_index = -1;
8607 else if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
8608 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != RETURN)
8610 /* Non-spill registers might be used at the call destination in
8611 some unknown fashion, so we have to mark the unknown use. */
8612 HARD_REG_SET *live;
8614 if ((condjump_p (insn) || condjump_in_parallel_p (insn))
8615 && JUMP_LABEL (insn))
8616 live = &LABEL_LIVE (JUMP_LABEL (insn));
8617 else
8618 live = &ever_live_at_start;
8620 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER - 1; i >= 0; --i)
8621 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (*live, i))
8622 reg_state[i].use_index = -1;
8625 reload_combine_note_use (&PATTERN (insn), insn);
8626 for (note = REG_NOTES (insn); note; note = XEXP (note, 1))
8628 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (note) == REG_INC
8629 && GET_CODE (XEXP (note, 0)) == REG)
8631 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (note, 0));
8633 reg_state[regno].store_ruid = reload_combine_ruid;
8634 reg_state[regno].use_index = -1;
8639 free (label_live);
8642 /* Check if DST is a register or a subreg of a register; if it is,
8643 update reg_state[regno].store_ruid and reg_state[regno].use_index
8644 accordingly. Called via note_stores from reload_combine. */
8646 static void
8647 reload_combine_note_store (dst, set, data)
8648 rtx dst, set;
8649 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
8651 int regno = 0;
8652 int i;
8653 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dst);
8655 if (GET_CODE (dst) == SUBREG)
8657 regno = SUBREG_WORD (dst);
8658 dst = SUBREG_REG (dst);
8660 if (GET_CODE (dst) != REG)
8661 return;
8662 regno += REGNO (dst);
8664 /* note_stores might have stripped a STRICT_LOW_PART, so we have to be
8665 careful with registers / register parts that are not full words.
8667 Similarly for ZERO_EXTRACT and SIGN_EXTRACT. */
8668 if (GET_CODE (set) != SET
8669 || GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == ZERO_EXTRACT
8670 || GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == SIGN_EXTRACT
8671 || GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == STRICT_LOW_PART)
8673 for (i = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode) - 1 + regno; i >= regno; i--)
8675 reg_state[i].use_index = -1;
8676 reg_state[i].store_ruid = reload_combine_ruid;
8679 else
8681 for (i = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode) - 1 + regno; i >= regno; i--)
8683 reg_state[i].store_ruid = reload_combine_ruid;
8684 reg_state[i].use_index = RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES;
8689 /* XP points to a piece of rtl that has to be checked for any uses of
8690 registers.
8691 *XP is the pattern of INSN, or a part of it.
8692 Called from reload_combine, and recursively by itself. */
8693 static void
8694 reload_combine_note_use (xp, insn)
8695 rtx *xp, insn;
8697 rtx x = *xp;
8698 enum rtx_code code = x->code;
8699 const char *fmt;
8700 int i, j;
8701 rtx offset = const0_rtx; /* For the REG case below. */
8703 switch (code)
8705 case SET:
8706 if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == REG)
8708 reload_combine_note_use (&SET_SRC (x), insn);
8709 return;
8711 break;
8713 case USE:
8714 /* If this is the USE of a return value, we can't change it. */
8715 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG && REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
8717 /* Mark the return register as used in an unknown fashion. */
8718 rtx reg = XEXP (x, 0);
8719 int regno = REGNO (reg);
8720 int nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (reg));
8722 while (--nregs >= 0)
8723 reg_state[regno + nregs].use_index = -1;
8724 return;
8726 break;
8728 case CLOBBER:
8729 if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == REG)
8730 return;
8731 break;
8733 case PLUS:
8734 /* We are interested in (plus (reg) (const_int)) . */
8735 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) != REG
8736 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) != CONST_INT)
8737 break;
8738 offset = XEXP (x, 1);
8739 x = XEXP (x, 0);
8740 /* Fall through. */
8741 case REG:
8743 int regno = REGNO (x);
8744 int use_index;
8745 int nregs;
8747 /* Some spurious USEs of pseudo registers might remain.
8748 Just ignore them. */
8749 if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8750 return;
8752 nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (x));
8754 /* We can't substitute into multi-hard-reg uses. */
8755 if (nregs > 1)
8757 while (--nregs >= 0)
8758 reg_state[regno + nregs].use_index = -1;
8759 return;
8762 /* If this register is already used in some unknown fashion, we
8763 can't do anything.
8764 If we decrement the index from zero to -1, we can't store more
8765 uses, so this register becomes used in an unknown fashion. */
8766 use_index = --reg_state[regno].use_index;
8767 if (use_index < 0)
8768 return;
8770 if (use_index != RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES - 1)
8772 /* We have found another use for a register that is already
8773 used later. Check if the offsets match; if not, mark the
8774 register as used in an unknown fashion. */
8775 if (! rtx_equal_p (offset, reg_state[regno].offset))
8777 reg_state[regno].use_index = -1;
8778 return;
8781 else
8783 /* This is the first use of this register we have seen since we
8784 marked it as dead. */
8785 reg_state[regno].offset = offset;
8786 reg_state[regno].use_ruid = reload_combine_ruid;
8788 reg_state[regno].reg_use[use_index].insn = insn;
8789 reg_state[regno].reg_use[use_index].usep = xp;
8790 return;
8793 default:
8794 break;
8797 /* Recursively process the components of X. */
8798 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
8799 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
8801 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
8802 reload_combine_note_use (&XEXP (x, i), insn);
8803 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
8805 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
8806 reload_combine_note_use (&XVECEXP (x, i, j), insn);
8811 /* See if we can reduce the cost of a constant by replacing a move with
8812 an add. */
8813 /* We cannot do our optimization across labels. Invalidating all the
8814 information about register contents we have would be costly, so we
8815 use last_label_luid (local variable of reload_cse_move2add) to note
8816 where the label is and then later disable any optimization that would
8817 cross it.
8818 reg_offset[n] / reg_base_reg[n] / reg_mode[n] are only valid if
8819 reg_set_luid[n] is larger than last_label_luid[n] . */
8820 static int reg_set_luid[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
8822 /* reg_offset[n] has to be CONST_INT for it and reg_base_reg[n] /
8823 reg_mode[n] to be valid.
8824 If reg_offset[n] is a CONST_INT and reg_base_reg[n] is negative, register n
8825 has been set to reg_offset[n] in mode reg_mode[n] .
8826 If reg_offset[n] is a CONST_INT and reg_base_reg[n] is non-negative,
8827 register n has been set to the sum of reg_offset[n] and register
8828 reg_base_reg[n], calculated in mode reg_mode[n] . */
8829 static rtx reg_offset[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
8830 static int reg_base_reg[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
8831 static enum machine_mode reg_mode[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
8833 /* move2add_luid is linearily increased while scanning the instructions
8834 from first to last. It is used to set reg_set_luid in
8835 reload_cse_move2add and move2add_note_store. */
8836 static int move2add_luid;
8838 /* Generate a CONST_INT and force it in the range of MODE. */
8840 static rtx
8841 gen_mode_int (mode, value)
8842 enum machine_mode mode;
8843 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
8845 HOST_WIDE_INT cval = value & GET_MODE_MASK (mode);
8846 int width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
8848 /* If MODE is narrower than HOST_WIDE_INT and CVAL is a negative number,
8849 sign extend it. */
8850 if (width > 0 && width < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8851 && (cval & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (width - 1))) != 0)
8852 cval |= (HOST_WIDE_INT) -1 << width;
8854 return GEN_INT (cval);
8857 static void
8858 reload_cse_move2add (first)
8859 rtx first;
8861 int i;
8862 rtx insn;
8863 int last_label_luid;
8865 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER - 1; i >= 0; i--)
8866 reg_set_luid[i] = 0;
8868 last_label_luid = 0;
8869 move2add_luid = 1;
8870 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn), move2add_luid++)
8872 rtx pat, note;
8874 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL)
8875 last_label_luid = move2add_luid;
8876 if (! INSN_P (insn))
8877 continue;
8878 pat = PATTERN (insn);
8879 /* For simplicity, we only perform this optimization on
8880 straightforward SETs. */
8881 if (GET_CODE (pat) == SET
8882 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (pat)) == REG)
8884 rtx reg = SET_DEST (pat);
8885 int regno = REGNO (reg);
8886 rtx src = SET_SRC (pat);
8888 /* Check if we have valid information on the contents of this
8889 register in the mode of REG. */
8890 /* ??? We don't know how zero / sign extension is handled, hence
8891 we can't go from a narrower to a wider mode. */
8892 if (reg_set_luid[regno] > last_label_luid
8893 && ((GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (reg))
8894 == GET_MODE_SIZE (reg_mode[regno]))
8895 || ((GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (reg))
8896 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (reg_mode[regno]))
8897 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (reg)),
8898 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (reg_mode[regno]))))
8899 && GET_CODE (reg_offset[regno]) == CONST_INT)
8901 /* Try to transform (set (REGX) (CONST_INT A))
8903 (set (REGX) (CONST_INT B))
8905 (set (REGX) (CONST_INT A))
8907 (set (REGX) (plus (REGX) (CONST_INT B-A))) */
8909 if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT && reg_base_reg[regno] < 0)
8911 int success = 0;
8912 rtx new_src
8913 = gen_mode_int (GET_MODE (reg),
8914 INTVAL (src) - INTVAL (reg_offset[regno]));
8915 /* (set (reg) (plus (reg) (const_int 0))) is not canonical;
8916 use (set (reg) (reg)) instead.
8917 We don't delete this insn, nor do we convert it into a
8918 note, to avoid losing register notes or the return
8919 value flag. jump2 already knowns how to get rid of
8920 no-op moves. */
8921 if (new_src == const0_rtx)
8922 success = validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (pat), reg, 0);
8923 else if (rtx_cost (new_src, PLUS) < rtx_cost (src, SET)
8924 && have_add2_insn (GET_MODE (reg)))
8925 success = validate_change (insn, &PATTERN (insn),
8926 gen_add2_insn (reg, new_src), 0);
8927 reg_set_luid[regno] = move2add_luid;
8928 reg_mode[regno] = GET_MODE (reg);
8929 reg_offset[regno] = src;
8930 continue;
8933 /* Try to transform (set (REGX) (REGY))
8934 (set (REGX) (PLUS (REGX) (CONST_INT A)))
8936 (set (REGX) (REGY))
8937 (set (REGX) (PLUS (REGX) (CONST_INT B)))
8939 (REGX) (REGY))
8940 (set (REGX) (PLUS (REGX) (CONST_INT A)))
8942 (set (REGX) (plus (REGX) (CONST_INT B-A))) */
8943 else if (GET_CODE (src) == REG
8944 && reg_base_reg[regno] == (int) REGNO (src)
8945 && reg_set_luid[regno] > reg_set_luid[REGNO (src)])
8947 rtx next = next_nonnote_insn (insn);
8948 rtx set = NULL_RTX;
8949 if (next)
8950 set = single_set (next);
8951 if (next
8952 && set
8953 && SET_DEST (set) == reg
8954 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == PLUS
8955 && XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0) == reg
8956 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1)) == CONST_INT)
8958 rtx src3 = XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1);
8959 rtx new_src
8960 = gen_mode_int (GET_MODE (reg),
8961 INTVAL (src3)
8962 - INTVAL (reg_offset[regno]));
8963 int success = 0;
8965 if (new_src == const0_rtx)
8966 /* See above why we create (set (reg) (reg)) here. */
8967 success
8968 = validate_change (next, &SET_SRC (set), reg, 0);
8969 else if ((rtx_cost (new_src, PLUS)
8970 < COSTS_N_INSNS (1) + rtx_cost (src3, SET))
8971 && have_add2_insn (GET_MODE (reg)))
8972 success
8973 = validate_change (next, &PATTERN (next),
8974 gen_add2_insn (reg, new_src), 0);
8975 if (success)
8977 /* INSN might be the first insn in a basic block
8978 if the preceding insn is a conditional jump
8979 or a possible-throwing call. */
8980 PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
8981 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
8982 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
8984 insn = next;
8985 reg_set_luid[regno] = move2add_luid;
8986 reg_mode[regno] = GET_MODE (reg);
8987 reg_offset[regno] = src3;
8988 continue;
8994 for (note = REG_NOTES (insn); note; note = XEXP (note, 1))
8996 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (note) == REG_INC
8997 && GET_CODE (XEXP (note, 0)) == REG)
8999 /* Indicate that this register has been recently written to,
9000 but the exact contents are not available. */
9001 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (note, 0));
9002 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
9004 reg_set_luid[regno] = move2add_luid;
9005 reg_offset[regno] = note;
9009 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), move2add_note_store, NULL);
9010 /* If this is a CALL_INSN, all call used registers are stored with
9011 unknown values. */
9012 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
9014 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER - 1; i >= 0; i--)
9016 if (call_used_regs[i])
9018 reg_set_luid[i] = move2add_luid;
9019 reg_offset[i] = insn; /* Invalidate contents. */
9026 /* SET is a SET or CLOBBER that sets DST.
9027 Update reg_set_luid, reg_offset and reg_base_reg accordingly.
9028 Called from reload_cse_move2add via note_stores. */
9030 static void
9031 move2add_note_store (dst, set, data)
9032 rtx dst, set;
9033 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
9035 unsigned int regno = 0;
9036 unsigned int i;
9037 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dst);
9039 if (GET_CODE (dst) == SUBREG)
9041 regno = SUBREG_WORD (dst);
9042 dst = SUBREG_REG (dst);
9045 /* Some targets do argument pushes without adding REG_INC notes. */
9047 if (GET_CODE (dst) == MEM)
9049 dst = XEXP (dst, 0);
9050 if (GET_CODE (dst) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (dst) == POST_DEC
9051 || GET_CODE (dst) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (dst) == POST_DEC)
9053 regno = REGNO (XEXP (dst, 0));
9054 reg_set_luid[regno] = move2add_luid;
9055 reg_offset[regno] = dst;
9057 return;
9059 if (GET_CODE (dst) != REG)
9060 return;
9062 regno += REGNO (dst);
9064 if (HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode) == 1 && GET_CODE (set) == SET
9065 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) != ZERO_EXTRACT
9066 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) != SIGN_EXTRACT
9067 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) != STRICT_LOW_PART)
9069 rtx src = SET_SRC (set);
9071 reg_mode[regno] = mode;
9072 switch (GET_CODE (src))
9074 case PLUS:
9076 rtx src0 = XEXP (src, 0);
9078 if (GET_CODE (src0) == REG)
9080 if (REGNO (src0) != regno
9081 || reg_offset[regno] != const0_rtx)
9083 reg_base_reg[regno] = REGNO (src0);
9084 reg_set_luid[regno] = move2add_luid;
9087 reg_offset[regno] = XEXP (src, 1);
9088 break;
9091 reg_set_luid[regno] = move2add_luid;
9092 reg_offset[regno] = set; /* Invalidate contents. */
9093 break;
9096 case REG:
9097 reg_base_reg[regno] = REGNO (SET_SRC (set));
9098 reg_offset[regno] = const0_rtx;
9099 reg_set_luid[regno] = move2add_luid;
9100 break;
9102 default:
9103 reg_base_reg[regno] = -1;
9104 reg_offset[regno] = SET_SRC (set);
9105 reg_set_luid[regno] = move2add_luid;
9106 break;
9109 else
9111 unsigned int endregno = regno + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode);
9113 for (i = regno; i < endregno; i++)
9115 /* Indicate that this register has been recently written to,
9116 but the exact contents are not available. */
9117 reg_set_luid[i] = move2add_luid;
9118 reg_offset[i] = dst;
9123 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
9124 static void
9125 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, x)
9126 rtx insn;
9127 rtx x;
9129 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
9130 const char *fmt;
9131 int i, j;
9133 if (code == MEM && auto_inc_p (XEXP (x, 0)))
9135 REG_NOTES (insn)
9136 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_INC, XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), REG_NOTES (insn));
9137 return;
9140 /* Scan all the operand sub-expressions. */
9141 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
9142 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
9144 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
9145 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, XEXP (x, i));
9146 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
9147 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
9148 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, XVECEXP (x, i, j));
9151 #endif